clang API Documentation
00001 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===// 00002 // 00003 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 00004 // 00005 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 00006 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 00007 // 00008 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 00009 // 00010 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 00011 // 00012 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 00013 00014 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 00015 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 00016 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 00017 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 00018 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 00019 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 00020 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 00021 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 00022 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 00023 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 00024 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 00025 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 00026 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 00027 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 00028 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 00029 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 00030 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 00031 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 00032 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 00033 #include <algorithm> 00034 00035 namespace clang { 00036 using namespace sema; 00037 00038 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a 00039 /// function. 00040 static ExprResult 00041 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 00042 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 00043 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 00044 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(), 00045 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 00046 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 00047 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 00048 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE); 00049 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take()); 00050 if (E.isInvalid()) 00051 return ExprError(); 00052 return move(E); 00053 } 00054 00055 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 00056 bool InOverloadResolution, 00057 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 00058 bool CStyle, 00059 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 00060 00061 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 00062 QualType &ToType, 00063 bool InOverloadResolution, 00064 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 00065 bool CStyle); 00066 static OverloadingResult 00067 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 00068 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 00069 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 00070 bool AllowExplicit); 00071 00072 00073 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 00074 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 00075 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 00076 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 00077 00078 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 00079 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 00080 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 00081 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 00082 00083 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 00084 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 00085 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 00086 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 00087 00088 00089 00090 /// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion 00091 /// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 00092 ImplicitConversionCategory 00093 GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 00094 static const ImplicitConversionCategory 00095 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 00096 ICC_Identity, 00097 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 00098 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 00099 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation, 00100 ICC_Identity, 00101 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment, 00102 ICC_Promotion, 00103 ICC_Promotion, 00104 ICC_Promotion, 00105 ICC_Conversion, 00106 ICC_Conversion, 00107 ICC_Conversion, 00108 ICC_Conversion, 00109 ICC_Conversion, 00110 ICC_Conversion, 00111 ICC_Conversion, 00112 ICC_Conversion, 00113 ICC_Conversion, 00114 ICC_Conversion, 00115 ICC_Conversion, 00116 ICC_Conversion, 00117 ICC_Conversion 00118 }; 00119 return Category[(int)Kind]; 00120 } 00121 00122 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 00123 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 00124 ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 00125 static const ImplicitConversionRank 00126 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 00127 ICR_Exact_Match, 00128 ICR_Exact_Match, 00129 ICR_Exact_Match, 00130 ICR_Exact_Match, 00131 ICR_Exact_Match, 00132 ICR_Exact_Match, 00133 ICR_Promotion, 00134 ICR_Promotion, 00135 ICR_Promotion, 00136 ICR_Conversion, 00137 ICR_Conversion, 00138 ICR_Conversion, 00139 ICR_Conversion, 00140 ICR_Conversion, 00141 ICR_Conversion, 00142 ICR_Conversion, 00143 ICR_Conversion, 00144 ICR_Conversion, 00145 ICR_Conversion, 00146 ICR_Conversion, 00147 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 00148 ICR_Conversion, 00149 ICR_Conversion, 00150 ICR_Writeback_Conversion 00151 }; 00152 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 00153 } 00154 00155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 00156 /// implicit conversion. 00157 const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 00158 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 00159 "No conversion", 00160 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 00161 "Array-to-pointer", 00162 "Function-to-pointer", 00163 "Noreturn adjustment", 00164 "Qualification", 00165 "Integral promotion", 00166 "Floating point promotion", 00167 "Complex promotion", 00168 "Integral conversion", 00169 "Floating conversion", 00170 "Complex conversion", 00171 "Floating-integral conversion", 00172 "Pointer conversion", 00173 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 00174 "Boolean conversion", 00175 "Compatible-types conversion", 00176 "Derived-to-base conversion", 00177 "Vector conversion", 00178 "Vector splat", 00179 "Complex-real conversion", 00180 "Block Pointer conversion", 00181 "Transparent Union Conversion" 00182 "Writeback conversion" 00183 }; 00184 return Name[Kind]; 00185 } 00186 00187 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 00188 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 00189 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 00190 First = ICK_Identity; 00191 Second = ICK_Identity; 00192 Third = ICK_Identity; 00193 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 00194 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 00195 ReferenceBinding = false; 00196 DirectBinding = false; 00197 IsLvalueReference = true; 00198 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 00199 BindsToRvalue = false; 00200 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 00201 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 00202 CopyConstructor = 0; 00203 } 00204 00205 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 00206 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 00207 /// implicit conversions. 00208 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 00209 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 00210 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 00211 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 00212 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 00213 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 00214 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 00215 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 00216 return Rank; 00217 } 00218 00219 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 00220 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 00221 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 00222 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 00223 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 00224 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 00225 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 00226 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 00227 // a pointer. 00228 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 00229 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 00230 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 00231 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 00232 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 00233 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 00234 return true; 00235 00236 return false; 00237 } 00238 00239 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 00240 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 00241 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 00242 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 00243 bool 00244 StandardConversionSequence:: 00245 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 00246 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 00247 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 00248 00249 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 00250 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 00251 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 00252 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 00253 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 00254 00255 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 00256 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 00257 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 00258 00259 return false; 00260 } 00261 00262 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 00263 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 00264 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) { 00265 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 00266 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 00267 case CK_NoOp: 00268 case CK_IntegralCast: 00269 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 00270 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 00271 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 00272 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 00273 case CK_FloatingCast: 00274 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 00275 continue; 00276 00277 default: 00278 return Converted; 00279 } 00280 } 00281 00282 return Converted; 00283 } 00284 00285 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 00286 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 00287 /// 00288 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 00289 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 00290 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 00291 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 00292 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 00293 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 00294 NarrowingKind 00295 StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx, 00296 const Expr *Converted, 00297 APValue &ConstantValue, 00298 QualType &ConstantType) const { 00299 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 00300 00301 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 00302 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 00303 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 00304 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 00305 switch (Second) { 00306 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 00307 // 00308 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 00309 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 00310 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 00311 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 00312 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 00313 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 00314 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 00315 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 00316 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue; 00317 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 00318 if (Initializer && 00319 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) { 00320 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 00321 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 00322 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(), 00323 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 00324 // And back. 00325 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue; 00326 bool ignored; 00327 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 00328 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 00329 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 00330 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 00331 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue); 00332 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 00333 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 00334 } 00335 } else { 00336 // Variables are always narrowings. 00337 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 00338 } 00339 } 00340 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 00341 00342 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 00343 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 00344 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 00345 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 00346 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 00347 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 00348 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 00349 // FromType is larger than ToType. 00350 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 00351 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 00352 // Constant! 00353 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 00354 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 00355 // Convert the source value into the target type. 00356 bool ignored; 00357 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 00358 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 00359 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 00360 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 00361 // values that can be represented. 00362 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 00363 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 00364 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 00365 } 00366 } else { 00367 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 00368 } 00369 } 00370 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 00371 00372 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 00373 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 00374 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 00375 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 00376 // value when converted back to the original type. 00377 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too. 00378 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 00379 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members 00380 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions. 00381 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 00382 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case. 00383 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: { 00384 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 00385 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 00386 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 00387 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 00388 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 00389 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 00390 00391 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 00392 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned)) { 00393 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 00394 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue; 00395 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 00396 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) { 00397 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 00398 00399 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 00400 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 00401 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 00402 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 00403 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 00404 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 00405 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 00406 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 00407 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 00408 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 00409 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 00410 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) { 00411 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 00412 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 00413 } 00414 } else { 00415 // Variables are always narrowings. 00416 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 00417 } 00418 } 00419 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 00420 } 00421 00422 default: 00423 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 00424 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 00425 } 00426 } 00427 00428 /// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 00429 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 00430 void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 00431 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 00432 bool PrintedSomething = false; 00433 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 00434 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 00435 PrintedSomething = true; 00436 } 00437 00438 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 00439 if (PrintedSomething) { 00440 OS << " -> "; 00441 } 00442 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 00443 00444 if (CopyConstructor) { 00445 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 00446 } else if (DirectBinding) { 00447 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 00448 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 00449 OS << " (reference binding)"; 00450 } 00451 PrintedSomething = true; 00452 } 00453 00454 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 00455 if (PrintedSomething) { 00456 OS << " -> "; 00457 } 00458 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 00459 PrintedSomething = true; 00460 } 00461 00462 if (!PrintedSomething) { 00463 OS << "No conversions required"; 00464 } 00465 } 00466 00467 /// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 00468 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 00469 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 00470 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 00471 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 00472 Before.DebugPrint(); 00473 OS << " -> "; 00474 } 00475 if (ConversionFunction) 00476 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 00477 else 00478 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 00479 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 00480 OS << " -> "; 00481 After.DebugPrint(); 00482 } 00483 } 00484 00485 /// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 00486 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 00487 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const { 00488 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 00489 switch (ConversionKind) { 00490 case StandardConversion: 00491 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 00492 Standard.DebugPrint(); 00493 break; 00494 case UserDefinedConversion: 00495 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 00496 UserDefined.DebugPrint(); 00497 break; 00498 case EllipsisConversion: 00499 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 00500 break; 00501 case AmbiguousConversion: 00502 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 00503 break; 00504 case BadConversion: 00505 OS << "Bad conversion"; 00506 break; 00507 } 00508 00509 OS << "\n"; 00510 } 00511 00512 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 00513 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 00514 } 00515 00516 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 00517 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 00518 } 00519 00520 void 00521 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 00522 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 00523 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 00524 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 00525 } 00526 00527 namespace { 00528 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store 00529 // template parameter and template argument information. 00530 struct DFIParamWithArguments { 00531 TemplateParameter Param; 00532 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 00533 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 00534 }; 00535 } 00536 00537 /// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 00538 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 00539 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo 00540 static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 00541 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 00542 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 00543 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result; 00544 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 00545 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 00546 Result.Data = 0; 00547 switch (TDK) { 00548 case Sema::TDK_Success: 00549 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 00550 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 00551 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 00552 break; 00553 00554 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 00555 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 00556 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 00557 break; 00558 00559 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 00560 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 00561 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 00562 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 00563 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 00564 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 00565 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 00566 Result.Data = Saved; 00567 break; 00568 } 00569 00570 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 00571 Result.Data = Info.take(); 00572 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 00573 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 00574 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 00575 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 00576 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 00577 } 00578 break; 00579 00580 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 00581 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 00582 break; 00583 } 00584 00585 return Result; 00586 } 00587 00588 void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 00589 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 00590 case Sema::TDK_Success: 00591 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 00592 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 00593 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 00594 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 00595 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 00596 break; 00597 00598 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 00599 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 00600 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 00601 Data = 0; 00602 break; 00603 00604 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 00605 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 00606 Data = 0; 00607 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 00608 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 00609 HasDiagnostic = false; 00610 } 00611 break; 00612 00613 // Unhandled 00614 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 00615 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 00616 break; 00617 } 00618 } 00619 00620 PartialDiagnosticAt * 00621 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 00622 if (HasDiagnostic) 00623 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 00624 return 0; 00625 } 00626 00627 TemplateParameter 00628 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 00629 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 00630 case Sema::TDK_Success: 00631 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 00632 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 00633 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 00634 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 00635 return TemplateParameter(); 00636 00637 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 00638 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 00639 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 00640 00641 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 00642 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 00643 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 00644 00645 // Unhandled 00646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 00647 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 00648 break; 00649 } 00650 00651 return TemplateParameter(); 00652 } 00653 00654 TemplateArgumentList * 00655 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 00656 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 00657 case Sema::TDK_Success: 00658 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 00659 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 00660 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 00661 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 00662 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 00663 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 00664 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 00665 return 0; 00666 00667 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 00668 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 00669 00670 // Unhandled 00671 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 00672 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 00673 break; 00674 } 00675 00676 return 0; 00677 } 00678 00679 const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 00680 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 00681 case Sema::TDK_Success: 00682 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 00683 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 00684 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 00685 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 00686 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 00687 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 00688 return 0; 00689 00690 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 00691 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 00692 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 00693 00694 // Unhandled 00695 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 00696 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 00697 break; 00698 } 00699 00700 return 0; 00701 } 00702 00703 const TemplateArgument * 00704 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 00705 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 00706 case Sema::TDK_Success: 00707 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 00708 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 00709 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 00710 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 00711 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 00712 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 00713 return 0; 00714 00715 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 00716 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 00717 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 00718 00719 // Unhandled 00720 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 00721 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 00722 break; 00723 } 00724 00725 return 0; 00726 } 00727 00728 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() { 00729 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) 00730 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii) 00731 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 00732 NumInlineSequences = 0; 00733 Candidates.clear(); 00734 Functions.clear(); 00735 } 00736 00737 namespace { 00738 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 00739 struct Entry { 00740 Expr **Addr; 00741 Expr *Saved; 00742 }; 00743 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 00744 00745 public: 00746 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 00747 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 00748 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 00749 Entries.push_back(entry); 00750 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 00751 } 00752 00753 void restore() { 00754 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 00755 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 00756 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 00757 } 00758 }; 00759 } 00760 00761 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 00762 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 00763 /// 00764 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 00765 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 00766 /// 00767 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 00768 static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 00769 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) { 00770 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 00771 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 00772 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 00773 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 00774 00775 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 00776 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 00777 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 00778 unbridgedCasts) { 00779 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 00780 return false; 00781 } 00782 00783 // Go ahead and check everything else. 00784 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 00785 if (result.isInvalid()) 00786 return true; 00787 00788 E = result.take(); 00789 return false; 00790 } 00791 00792 // Nothing to do. 00793 return false; 00794 } 00795 00796 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 00797 /// placeholders. 00798 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args, 00799 unsigned numArgs, 00800 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 00801 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i) 00802 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged)) 00803 return true; 00804 00805 return false; 00806 } 00807 00808 // IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an 00809 // overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if 00810 // New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same 00811 // signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old 00812 // declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When 00813 // it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New 00814 // cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on 00815 // top of the underlying declaration. 00816 // 00817 // Example: Given the following input: 00818 // 00819 // void f(int, float); // #1 00820 // void f(int, int); // #2 00821 // int f(int, int); // #3 00822 // 00823 // When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", 00824 // so IsOverload will not be used. 00825 // 00826 // When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By 00827 // comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded 00828 // (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns 00829 // false; MatchedDecl is unchanged. 00830 // 00831 // When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We 00832 // compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do 00833 // nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are 00834 // identical (return types of functions are not part of the 00835 // signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to 00836 // point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 00837 // 00838 // 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced 00839 // into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide 00840 // shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure 00841 // into a function template's signature. 00842 Sema::OverloadKind 00843 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 00844 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 00845 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 00846 I != E; ++I) { 00847 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 00848 00849 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 00850 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 00851 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 00852 00853 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 00854 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 00855 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 00856 00857 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 00858 } 00859 00860 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 00861 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 00862 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 00863 // function templates hide function templates with different 00864 // return types or template parameter lists. 00865 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 00866 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord(); 00867 00868 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) { 00869 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 00870 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 00871 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 00872 continue; 00873 } 00874 00875 Match = *I; 00876 return Ovl_Match; 00877 } 00878 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) { 00879 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 00880 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 00881 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 00882 continue; 00883 } 00884 00885 Match = *I; 00886 return Ovl_Match; 00887 } 00888 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) { 00889 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 00890 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 00891 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 00892 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 00893 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 00894 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 00895 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 00896 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 00897 // template instantiation. 00898 } else { 00899 // (C++ 13p1): 00900 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 00901 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 00902 Match = *I; 00903 return Ovl_NonFunction; 00904 } 00905 } 00906 00907 return Ovl_Overload; 00908 } 00909 00910 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 00911 bool UseUsingDeclRules) { 00912 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not 00913 // overloads. 00914 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC()) 00915 return false; 00916 00917 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 00918 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 00919 00920 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 00921 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 00922 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 00923 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0)) 00924 return true; 00925 00926 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 00927 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 00928 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 00929 00930 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 00931 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 00932 // in the signature, they are overloads. 00933 00934 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 00935 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 00936 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 00937 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 00938 return false; 00939 00940 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 00941 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 00942 00943 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 00944 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 00945 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 00946 if (OldQType != NewQType && 00947 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() || 00948 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 00949 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 00950 return true; 00951 00952 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 00953 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 00954 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 00955 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 00956 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 00957 // signature. 00958 // 00959 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 00960 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 00961 // 00962 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 00963 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 00964 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 00965 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 00966 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 00967 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 00968 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType())) 00969 return true; 00970 00971 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 00972 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 00973 // 00974 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 00975 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 00976 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 00977 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 00978 // can be overloaded. 00979 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 00980 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 00981 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 00982 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() && 00983 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() || 00984 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) { 00985 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && 00986 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() && 00987 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 00988 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 00989 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 00990 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 00991 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 00992 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 00993 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 00994 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 00995 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 00996 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 00997 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 00998 } 00999 01000 return true; 01001 } 01002 01003 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 01004 return false; 01005 } 01006 01007 /// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current 01008 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored. 01009 /// 01010 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside 01011 /// an available function, false otherwise. 01012 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) { 01013 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable(); 01014 } 01015 01016 /// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 01017 /// 01018 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 01019 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 01020 static ImplicitConversionSequence 01021 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 01022 bool SuppressUserConversions, 01023 bool AllowExplicit, 01024 bool InOverloadResolution, 01025 bool CStyle, 01026 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 01027 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 01028 01029 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 01030 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 01031 // we can perform. 01032 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 01033 return ICS; 01034 } 01035 01036 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 01037 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc()); 01038 OverloadingResult UserDefResult 01039 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions, 01040 AllowExplicit); 01041 01042 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) { 01043 ICS.setUserDefined(); 01044 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 01045 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 01046 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 01047 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 01048 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 01049 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 01050 // called for those cases. 01051 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 01052 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 01053 QualType FromCanon 01054 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 01055 QualType ToCanon 01056 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 01057 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 01058 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 01059 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 01060 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 01061 ICS.setStandard(); 01062 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 01063 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 01064 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 01065 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 01066 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 01067 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 01068 } 01069 } 01070 01071 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4: 01072 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined 01073 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when 01074 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step 01075 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or 01076 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and 01077 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed. 01078 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) { 01079 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType); 01080 } 01081 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) { 01082 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 01083 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 01084 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 01085 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 01086 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 01087 if (Cand->Viable) 01088 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 01089 } else { 01090 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 01091 } 01092 01093 return ICS; 01094 } 01095 01096 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 01097 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 01098 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 01099 /// to perform the initialization. Given 01100 /// 01101 /// void f(float f); 01102 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 01103 /// 01104 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 01105 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 01106 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 01107 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 01108 // 01109 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 01110 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 01111 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 01112 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 01113 /// "BadConversion". 01114 /// 01115 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 01116 /// not permitted. 01117 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 01118 /// permitted. 01119 /// 01120 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 01121 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 01122 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 01123 static ImplicitConversionSequence 01124 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 01125 bool SuppressUserConversions, 01126 bool AllowExplicit, 01127 bool InOverloadResolution, 01128 bool CStyle, 01129 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 01130 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 01131 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 01132 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 01133 ICS.setStandard(); 01134 return ICS; 01135 } 01136 01137 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 01138 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 01139 return ICS; 01140 } 01141 01142 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 01143 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 01144 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 01145 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 01146 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 01147 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 01148 // called for those cases. 01149 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 01150 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 01151 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 01152 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) { 01153 ICS.setStandard(); 01154 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 01155 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 01156 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 01157 01158 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 01159 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 01160 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 01161 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 01162 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 01163 01164 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 01165 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 01166 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 01167 01168 return ICS; 01169 } 01170 01171 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 01172 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 01173 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 01174 } 01175 01176 ImplicitConversionSequence 01177 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 01178 bool SuppressUserConversions, 01179 bool AllowExplicit, 01180 bool InOverloadResolution, 01181 bool CStyle, 01182 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 01183 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 01184 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit, 01185 InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 01186 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 01187 } 01188 01189 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 01190 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 01191 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 01192 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 01193 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 01194 ExprResult 01195 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 01196 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 01197 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 01198 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 01199 } 01200 01201 ExprResult 01202 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 01203 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 01204 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 01205 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 01206 return ExprError(); 01207 01208 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 01209 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 01210 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 01211 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 01212 01213 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 01214 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 01215 AllowExplicit, 01216 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 01217 /*CStyle=*/false, 01218 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 01219 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 01220 } 01221 01222 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 01223 /// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type. 01224 bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 01225 QualType &ResultTy) { 01226 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 01227 return false; 01228 01229 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 01230 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 01231 // - a pointer 01232 // - a member pointer 01233 // - a block pointer 01234 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 01235 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 01236 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 01237 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 01238 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 01239 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 01240 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 01241 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 01242 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 01243 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 01244 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 01245 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 01246 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 01247 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 01248 } else { 01249 return false; 01250 } 01251 01252 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 01253 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 01254 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 01255 return false; 01256 } 01257 01258 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 01259 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 01260 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false; 01261 01262 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 01263 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 01264 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 01265 01266 ResultTy = ToType; 01267 return true; 01268 } 01269 01270 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 01271 /// vector conversion. 01272 /// 01273 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 01274 /// conversion. 01275 static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType, 01276 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 01277 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 01278 // conversion. 01279 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 01280 return false; 01281 01282 // Identical types require no conversions. 01283 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 01284 return false; 01285 01286 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 01287 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 01288 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 01289 // identity conversion. 01290 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 01291 return false; 01292 01293 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 01294 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 01295 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 01296 return true; 01297 } 01298 } 01299 01300 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 01301 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 01302 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 01303 // same size 01304 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 01305 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 01306 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions && 01307 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 01308 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 01309 return true; 01310 } 01311 } 01312 01313 return false; 01314 } 01315 01316 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 01317 bool InOverloadResolution, 01318 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 01319 bool CStyle); 01320 01321 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 01322 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 01323 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 01324 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 01325 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 01326 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 01327 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 01328 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 01329 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 01330 bool InOverloadResolution, 01331 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 01332 bool CStyle, 01333 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 01334 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 01335 01336 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 01337 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 01338 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 01339 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 01340 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 01341 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0; 01342 01343 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 01344 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit 01345 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) { 01346 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 01347 return false; 01348 01349 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions, 01350 } 01351 01352 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 01353 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 01354 // (C++ 4p1). 01355 01356 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 01357 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 01358 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 01359 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 01360 AccessPair)) { 01361 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 01362 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 01363 FromType = Fn->getType(); 01364 01365 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 01366 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 01367 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 01368 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 01369 QualType resultTy; 01370 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 01371 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, 01372 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 01373 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 01374 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 01375 return false; 01376 } 01377 01378 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 01379 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 01380 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 01381 // expression. 01382 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 01383 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 01384 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 01385 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 01386 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 01387 == UO_AddrOf && 01388 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 01389 const Type *ClassType 01390 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 01391 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 01392 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 01393 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 01394 UO_AddrOf && 01395 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 01396 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 01397 } 01398 01399 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 01400 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 01401 FromType, 01402 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 01403 } else { 01404 return false; 01405 } 01406 } 01407 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 01408 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 01409 // be converted to a prvalue. 01410 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 01411 if (argIsLValue && 01412 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 01413 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 01414 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 01415 01416 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 01417 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 01418 // of the type of the lvalue ... 01419 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 01420 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 01421 01422 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 01423 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 01424 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 01425 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 01426 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01427 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 01428 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 01429 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 01430 01431 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 01432 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 01433 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 01434 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 01435 01436 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 01437 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4). 01438 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 01439 01440 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 01441 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 01442 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 01443 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 01444 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 01445 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 01446 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 01447 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 01448 return true; 01449 } 01450 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 01451 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 01452 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 01453 01454 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 01455 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 01456 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 01457 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 01458 } else { 01459 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 01460 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 01461 } 01462 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 01463 01464 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 01465 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 01466 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 01467 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 01468 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 01469 // conversion. 01470 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 01471 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 01472 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 01473 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 01474 // conversion to do. 01475 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 01476 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 01477 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 01478 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 01479 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01480 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 01481 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 01482 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 01483 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01484 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 01485 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 01486 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 01487 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01488 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 01489 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 01490 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 01491 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 01492 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 01493 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 01494 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 01495 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 01496 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 01497 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 01498 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 01499 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 01500 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 01501 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01502 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) { 01503 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 01504 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 01505 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01506 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 01507 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 01508 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 01509 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 01510 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01511 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 01512 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 01513 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 01514 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01515 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 01516 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 01517 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 01518 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 01519 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 01520 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 01521 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01522 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 01523 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 01524 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 01525 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 01526 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 01527 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 01528 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 01529 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 01530 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 01531 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 01532 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01533 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 01534 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 01535 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 01536 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 01537 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 01538 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 01539 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01540 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 01541 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 01542 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 01543 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 01544 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01545 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 01546 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion. 01547 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment; 01548 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 01549 InOverloadResolution, 01550 SCS, CStyle)) { 01551 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 01552 FromType = ToType; 01553 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 01554 CStyle)) { 01555 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 01556 // appropriately. 01557 return true; 01558 } else { 01559 // No second conversion required. 01560 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 01561 } 01562 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 01563 01564 QualType CanonFrom; 01565 QualType CanonTo; 01566 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1). 01567 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 01568 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 01569 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 01570 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 01571 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 01572 FromType = ToType; 01573 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 01574 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 01575 } else { 01576 // No conversion required 01577 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 01578 01579 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 01580 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 01581 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 01582 // a conversion. [...] 01583 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 01584 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 01585 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 01586 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 01587 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers() 01588 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr() 01589 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) { 01590 FromType = ToType; 01591 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 01592 } 01593 } 01594 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 01595 01596 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 01597 // this is a bad conversion sequence. 01598 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo) 01599 return false; 01600 01601 return true; 01602 } 01603 01604 static bool 01605 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 01606 QualType &ToType, 01607 bool InOverloadResolution, 01608 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 01609 bool CStyle) { 01610 01611 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 01612 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 01613 return false; 01614 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 01615 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 01616 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 01617 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(), 01618 itend = UD->field_end(); 01619 it != itend; ++it) { 01620 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 01621 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 01622 ToType = it->getType(); 01623 return true; 01624 } 01625 } 01626 return false; 01627 } 01628 01629 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 01630 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 01631 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 01632 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 01633 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 01634 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 01635 // All integers are built-in. 01636 if (!To) { 01637 return false; 01638 } 01639 01640 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 01641 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 01642 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 01643 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 01644 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 01645 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 01646 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 01647 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 01648 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 01649 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 01650 // less than int to an int. 01651 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && 01652 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) { 01653 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 01654 } 01655 01656 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 01657 } 01658 01659 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3: 01660 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 01661 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 01662 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 01663 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 01664 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 01665 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 01666 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 01667 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 01668 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 01669 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 01670 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 01671 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 01672 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 01673 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 01674 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 01675 return false; 01676 01677 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 01678 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 01679 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0)) 01680 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, 01681 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 01682 } 01683 01684 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 01685 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 01686 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 01687 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 01688 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 01689 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 01690 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 01691 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 01692 // type. 01693 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 01694 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 01695 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 01696 // unsigned. 01697 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 01698 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 01699 01700 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 01701 // order. Try each of these types. 01702 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 01703 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 01704 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 01705 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 01706 }; 01707 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 01708 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 01709 if (FromSize < ToSize || 01710 (FromSize == ToSize && 01711 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 01712 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 01713 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 01714 // promotion. 01715 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 01716 } 01717 } 01718 } 01719 01720 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 01721 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 01722 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 01723 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 01724 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 01725 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 01726 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 01727 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 01728 // conversion. 01729 using llvm::APSInt; 01730 if (From) 01731 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) { 01732 APSInt BitWidth; 01733 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 01734 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 01735 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 01736 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 01737 01738 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 01739 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 01740 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 01741 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 01742 } 01743 01744 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 01745 // that fits into an unsigned int? 01746 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 01747 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 01748 } 01749 01750 return false; 01751 } 01752 } 01753 01754 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 01755 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 01756 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 01757 return true; 01758 } 01759 01760 return false; 01761 } 01762 01763 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 01764 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 01765 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 01766 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 01767 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 01768 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 01769 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 01770 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 01771 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 01772 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 01773 return true; 01774 01775 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 01776 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 01777 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 01778 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 01779 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 01780 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 01781 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble)) 01782 return true; 01783 01784 // Half can be promoted to float. 01785 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 01786 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 01787 return true; 01788 } 01789 01790 return false; 01791 } 01792 01793 /// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 01794 /// 01795 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 01796 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 01797 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 01798 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 01799 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 01800 if (!FromComplex) 01801 return false; 01802 01803 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 01804 if (!ToComplex) 01805 return false; 01806 01807 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 01808 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 01809 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(), 01810 ToComplex->getElementType()); 01811 } 01812 01813 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 01814 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 01815 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 01816 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 01817 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 01818 /// 01819 static QualType 01820 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 01821 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 01822 ASTContext &Context, 01823 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 01824 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 01825 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 01826 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 01827 01828 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 01829 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 01830 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01831 01832 QualType CanonFromPointee 01833 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 01834 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 01835 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 01836 01837 if (StripObjCLifetime) 01838 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 01839 01840 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 01841 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 01842 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 01843 if (!ToType.isNull()) 01844 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 01845 01846 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 01847 // already. 01848 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 01849 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 01850 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 01851 } 01852 01853 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 01854 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 01855 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 01856 01857 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 01858 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 01859 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 01860 } 01861 01862 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 01863 bool InOverloadResolution, 01864 ASTContext &Context) { 01865 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 01866 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 01867 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 01868 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 01869 return !InOverloadResolution; 01870 01871 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 01872 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 01873 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 01874 } 01875 01876 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 01877 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 01878 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 01879 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 01880 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 01881 /// ConvertedType. 01882 /// 01883 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 01884 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 01885 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 01886 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 01887 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 01888 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 01889 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 01890 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 01891 /// should result in a warning. 01892 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 01893 bool InOverloadResolution, 01894 QualType& ConvertedType, 01895 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 01896 IncompatibleObjC = false; 01897 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 01898 IncompatibleObjC)) 01899 return true; 01900 01901 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 01902 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 01903 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 01904 ConvertedType = ToType; 01905 return true; 01906 } 01907 01908 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 01909 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 01910 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 01911 ConvertedType = ToType; 01912 return true; 01913 } 01914 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 01915 // pointer type. 01916 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 01917 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 01918 ConvertedType = ToType; 01919 return true; 01920 } 01921 01922 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 01923 // pointer constant. 01924 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 01925 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 01926 ConvertedType = ToType; 01927 return true; 01928 } 01929 01930 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 01931 if (!ToTypePtr) 01932 return false; 01933 01934 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 01935 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 01936 ConvertedType = ToType; 01937 return true; 01938 } 01939 01940 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 01941 // , including objective-c pointers. 01942 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 01943 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 01944 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 01945 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 01946 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 01947 ToPointeeType, 01948 ToType, Context); 01949 return true; 01950 } 01951 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 01952 if (!FromTypePtr) 01953 return false; 01954 01955 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 01956 01957 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 01958 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 01959 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 01960 return false; 01961 01962 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 01963 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 01964 // 4.10p2). 01965 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 01966 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 01967 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 01968 ToPointeeType, 01969 ToType, Context, 01970 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 01971 return true; 01972 } 01973 01974 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 01975 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 01976 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 01977 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 01978 ToPointeeType, 01979 ToType, Context); 01980 return true; 01981 } 01982 01983 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 01984 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 01985 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 01986 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 01987 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 01988 ToPointeeType, 01989 ToType, Context); 01990 return true; 01991 } 01992 01993 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 01994 // 01995 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 01996 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 01997 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 01998 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 01999 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 02000 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 02001 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 02002 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 02003 // 02004 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 02005 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 02006 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 02007 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 02008 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 02009 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) && 02010 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 02011 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 02012 ToPointeeType, 02013 ToType, Context); 02014 return true; 02015 } 02016 02017 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 02018 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 02019 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 02020 ToPointeeType, 02021 ToType, Context); 02022 return true; 02023 } 02024 02025 return false; 02026 } 02027 02028 /// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 02029 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 02030 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 02031 02032 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 02033 if (TQs == Qs) 02034 return T; 02035 02036 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 02037 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 02038 02039 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 02040 } 02041 02042 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 02043 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 02044 /// with the same arguments and return values. 02045 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 02046 QualType& ConvertedType, 02047 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 02048 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 02049 return false; 02050 02051 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 02052 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 02053 02054 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 02055 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 02056 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 02057 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 02058 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 02059 02060 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 02061 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 02062 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 02063 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 02064 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 02065 return false; 02066 02067 // Check for compatible 02068 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a 02069 // pointer to any interface (in both directions). 02070 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 02071 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 02072 return true; 02073 } 02074 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>. 02075 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 02076 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 02077 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType, 02078 /*compare=*/false)) { 02079 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 02080 return true; 02081 } 02082 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an 02083 // interface to a pointer to a different interface. 02084 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 02085 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 02086 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 02087 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 02088 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 02089 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 02090 return false; 02091 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 02092 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 02093 ToType, Context); 02094 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 02095 return true; 02096 } 02097 02098 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 02099 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 02100 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 02101 // complain about it. 02102 IncompatibleObjC = true; 02103 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 02104 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 02105 ToType, Context); 02106 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 02107 return true; 02108 } 02109 } 02110 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 02111 QualType ToPointeeType; 02112 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 02113 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 02114 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 02115 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 02116 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 02117 // to a block pointer type. 02118 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 02119 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 02120 return true; 02121 } 02122 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 02123 } 02124 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 02125 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 02126 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 02127 // pointer to any object. 02128 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 02129 return true; 02130 } 02131 else 02132 return false; 02133 02134 QualType FromPointeeType; 02135 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 02136 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 02137 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 02138 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 02139 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 02140 else 02141 return false; 02142 02143 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 02144 // is an Objective-C conversion. 02145 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 02146 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 02147 IncompatibleObjC)) { 02148 // We always complain about this conversion. 02149 IncompatibleObjC = true; 02150 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 02151 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 02152 return true; 02153 } 02154 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 02155 // as in I* to id. 02156 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 02157 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 02158 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 02159 IncompatibleObjC)) { 02160 02161 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 02162 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 02163 return true; 02164 } 02165 02166 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 02167 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 02168 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 02169 // complain about it). 02170 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 02171 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 02172 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 02173 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 02174 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 02175 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 02176 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 02177 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 02178 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 02179 return false; 02180 02181 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 02182 // function types are obviously different. 02183 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() || 02184 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 02185 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals()) 02186 return false; 02187 02188 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 02189 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType()) 02190 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) { 02191 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 02192 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(), 02193 ToFunctionType->getResultType(), 02194 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 02195 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 02196 HasObjCConversion = true; 02197 } else { 02198 // Function types are too different. Abort. 02199 return false; 02200 } 02201 02202 // Check argument types. 02203 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs(); 02204 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 02205 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 02206 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 02207 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 02208 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 02209 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 02210 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 02211 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 02212 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 02213 HasObjCConversion = true; 02214 } else { 02215 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 02216 return false; 02217 } 02218 } 02219 02220 if (HasObjCConversion) { 02221 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 02222 // conversion, but complain about it. 02223 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 02224 IncompatibleObjC = true; 02225 return true; 02226 } 02227 } 02228 02229 return false; 02230 } 02231 02232 /// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 02233 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 02234 /// 02235 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 02236 /// 02237 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 02238 /// 02239 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 02240 /// this conversion. 02241 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 02242 QualType &ConvertedType) { 02243 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 02244 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 02245 return false; 02246 02247 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 02248 QualType ToPointee; 02249 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 02250 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 02251 else 02252 return false; 02253 02254 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 02255 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 02256 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 02257 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 02258 return false; 02259 02260 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 02261 QualType FromPointee; 02262 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 02263 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 02264 else 02265 return false; 02266 02267 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 02268 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 02269 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 02270 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 02271 return false; 02272 02273 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 02274 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 02275 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 02276 return false; 02277 02278 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 02279 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 02280 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 02281 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 02282 02283 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 02284 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 02285 bool IncompatibleObjC; 02286 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 02287 FromPointee = ToPointee; 02288 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 02289 IncompatibleObjC)) 02290 return false; 02291 02292 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 02293 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 02294 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 02295 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 02296 return true; 02297 } 02298 02299 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 02300 QualType& ConvertedType) { 02301 QualType ToPointeeType; 02302 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 02303 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 02304 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 02305 else 02306 return false; 02307 02308 QualType FromPointeeType; 02309 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 02310 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 02311 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 02312 else 02313 return false; 02314 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 02315 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 02316 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 02317 02318 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 02319 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 02320 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 02321 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 02322 02323 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 02324 return false; 02325 02326 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 02327 return true; 02328 02329 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 02330 // function types are obviously different. 02331 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() || 02332 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 02333 return false; 02334 02335 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 02336 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 02337 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 02338 return false; 02339 02340 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 02341 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(), 02342 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) { 02343 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 02344 } else { 02345 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType(); 02346 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType(); 02347 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 02348 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 02349 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 02350 02351 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 02352 // OK exact match. 02353 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 02354 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 02355 if (IncompatibleObjC) 02356 return false; 02357 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 02358 } 02359 else 02360 return false; 02361 } 02362 02363 // Check argument types. 02364 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs(); 02365 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 02366 IncompatibleObjC = false; 02367 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 02368 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx); 02369 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 02370 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 02371 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 02372 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 02373 if (IncompatibleObjC) 02374 return false; 02375 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 02376 } else 02377 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 02378 return false; 02379 } 02380 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount && 02381 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType, 02382 ToFunctionType)) 02383 return false; 02384 02385 ConvertedType = ToType; 02386 return true; 02387 } 02388 02389 enum { 02390 ft_default, 02391 ft_different_class, 02392 ft_parameter_arity, 02393 ft_parameter_mismatch, 02394 ft_return_type, 02395 ft_qualifer_mismatch 02396 }; 02397 02398 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 02399 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 02400 /// parameter types, and different return types. 02401 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 02402 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 02403 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 02404 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 02405 PDiag << ft_default; 02406 return; 02407 } 02408 02409 // Get the function type from the pointers. 02410 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 02411 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(), 02412 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 02413 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) { 02414 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 02415 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 02416 return; 02417 } 02418 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 02419 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 02420 } 02421 02422 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 02423 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 02424 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 02425 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 02426 02427 // Remove references. 02428 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 02429 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 02430 02431 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 02432 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 02433 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 02434 PDiag << ft_default; 02435 return; 02436 } 02437 02438 // No extra info for same types. 02439 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 02440 PDiag << ft_default; 02441 return; 02442 } 02443 02444 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), 02445 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 02446 02447 // Both types need to be function types. 02448 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 02449 PDiag << ft_default; 02450 return; 02451 } 02452 02453 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) { 02454 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs() 02455 << FromFunction->getNumArgs(); 02456 return; 02457 } 02458 02459 // Handle different parameter types. 02460 unsigned ArgPos; 02461 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 02462 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 02463 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos) 02464 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos); 02465 return; 02466 } 02467 02468 // Handle different return type. 02469 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(), 02470 ToFunction->getResultType())) { 02471 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType() 02472 << FromFunction->getResultType(); 02473 return; 02474 } 02475 02476 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(), 02477 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals(); 02478 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) { 02479 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals; 02480 return; 02481 } 02482 02483 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 02484 PDiag << ft_default; 02485 } 02486 02487 /// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 02488 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 02489 /// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C 02490 /// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal. 02491 /// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the the parameter index 02492 /// of the first different parameter. 02493 bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 02494 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 02495 unsigned *ArgPos) { 02496 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) { 02497 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(), 02498 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(), 02499 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 02500 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) { 02501 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin(); 02502 return false; 02503 } 02504 } 02505 return true; 02506 } 02507 02508 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(), 02509 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(), 02510 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 02511 QualType ToType = (*O); 02512 QualType FromType = (*N); 02513 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) { 02514 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 02515 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 02516 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && 02517 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) || 02518 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && 02519 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType())) 02520 continue; 02521 } 02522 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo = 02523 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 02524 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr = 02525 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 02526 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 02527 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(), 02528 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType())) 02529 continue; 02530 } 02531 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin(); 02532 return false; 02533 } 02534 } 02535 return true; 02536 } 02537 02538 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 02539 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 02540 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 02541 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 02542 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 02543 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 02544 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 02545 CastKind &Kind, 02546 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 02547 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 02548 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 02549 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 02550 02551 Kind = CK_BitCast; 02552 02553 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 02554 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) && 02555 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 02556 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 02557 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 02558 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 02559 02560 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 02561 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 02562 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 02563 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 02564 02565 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 02566 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 02567 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 02568 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 02569 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, 02570 From->getExprLoc(), 02571 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath, 02572 IgnoreBaseAccess)) 02573 return true; 02574 02575 // The conversion was successful. 02576 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 02577 } 02578 } 02579 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 02580 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 02581 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 02582 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 02583 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 02584 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 02585 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 02586 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 02587 return false; 02588 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 02589 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 02590 } else { 02591 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 02592 } 02593 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 02594 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 02595 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 02596 } 02597 02598 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 02599 // reasons. 02600 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 02601 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 02602 02603 return false; 02604 } 02605 02606 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 02607 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 02608 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 02609 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 02610 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 02611 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 02612 QualType ToType, 02613 bool InOverloadResolution, 02614 QualType &ConvertedType) { 02615 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 02616 if (!ToTypePtr) 02617 return false; 02618 02619 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 02620 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 02621 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 02622 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 02623 ConvertedType = ToType; 02624 return true; 02625 } 02626 02627 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 02628 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 02629 if (!FromTypePtr) 02630 return false; 02631 02632 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 02633 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 02634 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 02635 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 02636 02637 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 02638 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) && 02639 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) { 02640 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 02641 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 02642 return true; 02643 } 02644 02645 return false; 02646 } 02647 02648 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 02649 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 02650 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 02651 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 02652 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 02653 /// otherwise. 02654 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 02655 CastKind &Kind, 02656 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 02657 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 02658 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 02659 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 02660 if (!FromPtrType) { 02661 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 02662 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 02663 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 02664 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 02665 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 02666 return false; 02667 } 02668 02669 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 02670 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 02671 "that is not a member pointer."); 02672 02673 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 02674 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 02675 02676 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 02677 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 02678 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 02679 02680 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 02681 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 02682 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 02683 assert(DerivationOkay && 02684 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 02685 (void)DerivationOkay; 02686 02687 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 02688 getUnqualifiedType())) { 02689 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 02690 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 02691 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 02692 return true; 02693 } 02694 02695 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 02696 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 02697 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 02698 << From->getSourceRange(); 02699 return true; 02700 } 02701 02702 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 02703 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 02704 Paths.front(), 02705 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 02706 02707 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 02708 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 02709 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 02710 return false; 02711 } 02712 02713 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 02714 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 02715 /// (C++ 4.4). 02716 /// 02717 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 02718 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 02719 /// object lifetime. 02720 bool 02721 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 02722 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 02723 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 02724 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 02725 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 02726 02727 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 02728 // qualification conversion. 02729 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 02730 return false; 02731 02732 // (C++ 4.4p4): 02733 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 02734 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 02735 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 02736 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 02737 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 02738 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 02739 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 02740 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 02741 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 02742 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to 02743 // unwrap. 02744 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 02745 02746 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 02747 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 02748 02749 // Objective-C ARC: 02750 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 02751 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() && 02752 UnwrappedAnyPointer) { 02753 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 02754 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 02755 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 02756 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 02757 } else { 02758 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 02759 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 02760 return false; 02761 } 02762 } 02763 02764 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 02765 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 02766 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 02767 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 02768 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 02769 } 02770 02771 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 02772 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 02773 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 02774 return false; 02775 02776 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 02777 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 02778 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() 02779 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 02780 return false; 02781 02782 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 02783 // include const. 02784 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst 02785 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 02786 } 02787 02788 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 02789 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 02790 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 02791 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 02792 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 02793 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 02794 } 02795 02796 /// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 02797 /// atomic type. 02798 /// 02799 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 02800 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 02801 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 02802 bool InOverloadResolution, 02803 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 02804 bool CStyle) { 02805 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 02806 if (!ToAtomic) 02807 return false; 02808 02809 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 02810 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 02811 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 02812 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 02813 return false; 02814 02815 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 02816 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 02817 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 02818 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 02819 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 02820 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 02821 return true; 02822 } 02823 02824 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 02825 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 02826 QualType Type) { 02827 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType = 02828 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 02829 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) { 02830 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0); 02831 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 02832 return true; 02833 } 02834 return false; 02835 } 02836 02837 static OverloadingResult 02838 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 02839 CXXRecordDecl *To, 02840 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 02841 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 02842 bool AllowExplicit) { 02843 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd; 02844 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(To); 02845 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 02846 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 02847 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 02848 02849 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 02850 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0; 02851 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 02852 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 02853 if (ConstructorTmpl) 02854 Constructor 02855 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 02856 else 02857 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 02858 02859 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 02860 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) && 02861 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit()); 02862 if (Usable) { 02863 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 02864 // suppress conversions. 02865 bool SuppressUserConversions = 02866 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType); 02867 if (ConstructorTmpl) 02868 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 02869 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 02870 From, CandidateSet, 02871 SuppressUserConversions); 02872 else 02873 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 02874 From, CandidateSet, 02875 SuppressUserConversions); 02876 } 02877 } 02878 02879 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 02880 02881 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 02882 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) { 02883 case OR_Success: { 02884 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 02885 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 02886 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor); 02887 02888 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 02889 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 02890 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 02891 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 02892 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 02893 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 02894 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 02895 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 02896 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 02897 return OR_Success; 02898 } 02899 02900 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 02901 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 02902 case OR_Deleted: 02903 return OR_Deleted; 02904 case OR_Ambiguous: 02905 return OR_Ambiguous; 02906 } 02907 02908 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 02909 } 02910 02911 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 02912 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 02913 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 02914 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 02915 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 02916 /// false and User is unspecified. 02917 /// 02918 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 02919 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 02920 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 02921 static OverloadingResult 02922 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 02923 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 02924 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 02925 bool AllowExplicit) { 02926 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 02927 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 02928 02929 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 02930 // constructors. 02931 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 02932 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 02933 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 02934 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 02935 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 02936 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 02937 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 02938 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 02939 // the parentheses of the initializer. 02940 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 02941 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 02942 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType))) 02943 ConstructorsOnly = true; 02944 02945 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0); 02946 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl 02947 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now 02948 // to try to recover. 02949 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) { 02950 // We're not going to find any constructors. 02951 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 02952 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 02953 02954 Expr **Args = &From; 02955 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 02956 bool ListInitializing = false; 02957 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 02958 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work. 02959 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 02960 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit); 02961 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 02962 return Result; 02963 // Never mind. 02964 CandidateSet.clear(); 02965 02966 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 02967 // arguments, not the entire list. 02968 Args = InitList->getInits(); 02969 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 02970 ListInitializing = true; 02971 } 02972 02973 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd; 02974 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl); 02975 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) { 02976 NamedDecl *D = *Con; 02977 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess()); 02978 02979 // Find the constructor (which may be a template). 02980 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0; 02981 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl 02982 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 02983 if (ConstructorTmpl) 02984 Constructor 02985 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()); 02986 else 02987 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D); 02988 02989 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 02990 if (ListInitializing) 02991 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit()); 02992 else 02993 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit); 02994 if (Usable) { 02995 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 02996 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 02997 SuppressUserConversions = false; 02998 if (NumArgs == 1) { 02999 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 03000 // suppress conversions. 03001 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 03002 S.Context, Constructor, ToType); 03003 } 03004 } 03005 if (ConstructorTmpl) 03006 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl, 03007 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 03008 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 03009 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 03010 else 03011 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 03012 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 03013 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl, 03014 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 03015 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 03016 } 03017 } 03018 } 03019 } 03020 03021 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 03022 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 03023 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) { 03024 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 03025 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType 03026 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 03027 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 03028 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 03029 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 03030 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 03031 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 03032 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 03033 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 03034 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 03035 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 03036 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 03037 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 03038 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 03039 03040 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 03041 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 03042 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 03043 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 03044 else 03045 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 03046 03047 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 03048 if (ConvTemplate) 03049 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, 03050 ActingContext, From, ToType, 03051 CandidateSet); 03052 else 03053 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 03054 From, ToType, CandidateSet); 03055 } 03056 } 03057 } 03058 } 03059 03060 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 03061 03062 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 03063 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) { 03064 case OR_Success: 03065 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 03066 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 03067 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 03068 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor); 03069 03070 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 03071 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 03072 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 03073 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 03074 // the argument of the constructor. 03075 // 03076 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 03077 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 03078 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 03079 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 03080 } else { 03081 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 03082 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 03083 else { 03084 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 03085 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 03086 } 03087 } 03088 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 03089 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 03090 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 03091 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 03092 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 03093 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 03094 return OR_Success; 03095 } 03096 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 03097 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 03098 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion); 03099 03100 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 03101 // 03102 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 03103 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 03104 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 03105 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 03106 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 03107 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 03108 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 03109 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 03110 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 03111 03112 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 03113 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 03114 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 03115 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 03116 // is an initialization, the special rules for 03117 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 03118 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 03119 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 03120 // 13.3.3.1). 03121 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 03122 return OR_Success; 03123 } 03124 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 03125 03126 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 03127 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 03128 case OR_Deleted: 03129 // No conversion here! We're done. 03130 return OR_Deleted; 03131 03132 case OR_Ambiguous: 03133 return OR_Ambiguous; 03134 } 03135 03136 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 03137 } 03138 03139 bool 03140 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 03141 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 03142 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc()); 03143 OverloadingResult OvResult = 03144 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 03145 CandidateSet, false); 03146 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 03147 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 03148 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 03149 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 03150 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) 03151 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 03152 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 03153 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 03154 else 03155 return false; 03156 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From); 03157 return true; 03158 } 03159 03160 /// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 03161 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 03162 /// is possible. 03163 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 03164 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, 03165 FunctionDecl *Function1, 03166 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 03167 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus0x) 03168 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03169 03170 // Objective-C++: 03171 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 03172 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 03173 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 03174 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 03175 // to keep code working. 03176 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 03177 if (!Conv1) 03178 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03179 03180 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 03181 if (!Conv2) 03182 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03183 03184 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 03185 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 03186 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 03187 if (Block1 != Block2) 03188 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 03189 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03190 } 03191 03192 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03193 } 03194 03195 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 03196 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 03197 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 03198 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 03199 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, 03200 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 03201 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 03202 { 03203 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 03204 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 03205 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 03206 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 03207 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 03208 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 03209 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 03210 // (13.3.3.1.3). 03211 // 03212 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 03213 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 03214 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 03215 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 03216 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 03217 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 03218 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03219 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 03220 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03221 03222 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 03223 // the same kind. 03224 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 03225 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03226 03227 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 03228 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03229 03230 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 03231 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 03232 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 03233 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 03234 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 03235 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 03236 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 03237 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 03238 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 03239 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 03240 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 03241 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 03242 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 03243 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 03244 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 03245 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 03246 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 03247 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 03248 else 03249 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 03250 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 03251 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 03252 } 03253 03254 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 03255 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> 03256 // for some X and L2 does not. 03257 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable && 03258 !ICS1.isBad() && 03259 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() && 03260 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) { 03261 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 03262 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 03263 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03264 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 03265 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 03266 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03267 } 03268 03269 return Result; 03270 } 03271 03272 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) { 03273 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 03274 Qualifiers Quals; 03275 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 03276 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 03277 } 03278 03279 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2); 03280 } 03281 03282 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 03283 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 03284 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 03285 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 03286 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 03287 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 03288 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 03289 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03290 03291 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 03292 // any non-identity conversion sequence 03293 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 03294 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03295 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 03296 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03297 03298 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 03299 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 03300 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03301 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 03302 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03303 else 03304 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03305 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 03306 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03307 03308 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 03309 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 03310 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03311 } 03312 03313 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 03314 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 03315 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 03316 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03317 03318 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 03319 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 03320 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 03321 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03322 03323 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03324 } 03325 03326 /// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 03327 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 03328 static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 03329 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 03330 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 03331 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 03332 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 03333 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 03334 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 03335 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 03336 // reference*. 03337 // 03338 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 03339 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 03340 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 03341 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 03342 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 03343 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 03344 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 03345 return false; 03346 03347 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 03348 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 03349 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 03350 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference); 03351 } 03352 03353 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 03354 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 03355 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 03356 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 03357 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, 03358 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 03359 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 03360 { 03361 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 03362 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 03363 03364 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 03365 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 03366 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 03367 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 03368 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 03369 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 03370 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 03371 return CK; 03372 03373 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 03374 // defined below), or, if not that, 03375 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 03376 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 03377 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 03378 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03379 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 03380 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03381 03382 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 03383 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 03384 // applies: 03385 03386 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 03387 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 03388 // that is such a conversion. 03389 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 03390 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 03391 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 03392 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03393 03394 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 03395 // 03396 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 03397 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 03398 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 03399 // of B* to void*. 03400 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 03401 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 03402 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 03403 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 03404 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 03405 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 03406 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 03407 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 03408 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03409 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 03410 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 03411 // their derived-to-base conversions. 03412 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 03413 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 03414 return DerivedCK; 03415 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 03416 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 03417 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 03418 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 03419 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 03420 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 03421 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 03422 03423 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 03424 // conversion, if we need to. 03425 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 03426 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 03427 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 03428 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 03429 03430 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 03431 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 03432 03433 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 03434 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03435 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 03436 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03437 03438 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 03439 // other, it is the better one. 03440 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 03441 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 03442 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 03443 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 03444 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 03445 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 03446 FromObjCPtr2); 03447 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 03448 FromObjCPtr1); 03449 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 03450 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 03451 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03452 } 03453 } 03454 } 03455 03456 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 03457 // bullet 3). 03458 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 03459 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 03460 return QualCK; 03461 03462 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 03463 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 03464 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 03465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03466 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 03467 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03468 03469 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 03470 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 03471 // which the references refer are the same type except for 03472 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 03473 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 03474 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 03475 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 03476 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 03477 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 03478 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 03479 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 03480 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 03481 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 03482 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 03483 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 03484 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 03485 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 03486 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 03487 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 03488 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 03489 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03490 } 03491 03492 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 03493 // type for comparison. 03494 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 03495 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 03496 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 03497 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 03498 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 03499 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03500 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 03501 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03502 } 03503 } 03504 03505 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 03506 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 03507 // is between types of the same size. 03508 // For example: 03509 // void f(float); 03510 // void f(int); 03511 // int main { 03512 // long a; 03513 // f(a); 03514 // } 03515 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 03516 // as clang will do in standard mode. 03517 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && 03518 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 03519 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 03520 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 03521 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 03522 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03523 03524 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03525 } 03526 03527 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 03528 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 03529 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 03530 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 03531 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 03532 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 03533 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 03534 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 03535 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 03536 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 03537 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 03538 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 03539 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 03540 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 03541 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 03542 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03543 03544 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 03545 // conversion (!) 03546 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 03547 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 03548 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 03549 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 03550 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 03551 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 03552 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 03553 03554 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped 03555 // them. 03556 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 03557 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03558 03559 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 03560 // for comparison. 03561 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 03562 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 03563 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 03564 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 03565 03566 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 03567 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03568 03569 // Objective-C++ ARC: 03570 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 03571 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 03572 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 03573 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 03574 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 03575 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 03576 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03577 } 03578 03579 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 03580 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 03581 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 03582 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 03583 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 03584 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 03585 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 03586 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 03587 // strict subset of qualifiers. 03588 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers()) 03589 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 03590 // about how the sequences rank. 03591 ; 03592 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 03593 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 03594 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 03595 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 03596 // qualifiers. 03597 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03598 03599 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03600 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 03601 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 03602 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 03603 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 03604 // qualifiers. 03605 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03606 03607 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03608 } else { 03609 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 03610 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03611 } 03612 03613 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 03614 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 03615 break; 03616 } 03617 03618 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 03619 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 03620 switch (Result) { 03621 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 03622 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 03623 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03624 break; 03625 03626 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 03627 break; 03628 03629 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 03630 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 03631 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03632 break; 03633 } 03634 03635 return Result; 03636 } 03637 03638 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 03639 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 03640 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 03641 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 03642 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 03643 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 03644 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, 03645 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 03646 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 03647 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 03648 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 03649 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 03650 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 03651 03652 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 03653 // conversion, if we need to. 03654 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 03655 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 03656 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 03657 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 03658 03659 // Canonicalize all of the types. 03660 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 03661 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 03662 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 03663 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 03664 03665 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 03666 // 03667 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 03668 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 03669 // 03670 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 03671 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 03672 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 03673 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 03674 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 03675 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 03676 QualType FromPointee1 03677 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 03678 QualType ToPointee1 03679 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 03680 QualType FromPointee2 03681 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 03682 QualType ToPointee2 03683 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 03684 03685 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 03686 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 03687 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 03688 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03689 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 03690 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03691 } 03692 03693 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 03694 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 03695 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 03696 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03697 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 03698 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03699 } 03700 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 03701 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 03702 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 03703 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 03704 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 03705 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 03706 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 03707 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 03708 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 03709 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 03710 03711 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 03712 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 03713 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 03714 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 03715 // Objective-C pointer types. 03716 bool FromAssignLeft 03717 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 03718 bool FromAssignRight 03719 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 03720 bool ToAssignLeft 03721 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 03722 bool ToAssignRight 03723 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 03724 03725 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 03726 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 03727 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 03728 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 03729 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03730 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 03731 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 03732 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03733 03734 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 03735 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 03736 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 03737 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03738 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 03739 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03740 03741 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 03742 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 03743 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 03744 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 03745 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03746 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 03747 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 03748 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03749 03750 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 03751 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 03752 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 03753 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03754 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 03755 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03756 03757 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 03758 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 03759 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 03760 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) 03761 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 03762 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03763 03764 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 03765 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 03766 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 03767 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 03768 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03769 } 03770 } 03771 03772 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 03773 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 03774 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 03775 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 03776 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 = 03777 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 03778 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 = 03779 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 03780 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 = 03781 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 03782 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 = 03783 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 03784 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 03785 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 03786 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 03787 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 03788 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 03789 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 03790 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 03791 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 03792 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 03793 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 03794 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 03795 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03796 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 03797 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03798 } 03799 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 03800 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 03801 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 03802 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03803 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 03804 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03805 } 03806 } 03807 03808 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 03809 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 03810 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 03811 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 03812 // reference of type A&, 03813 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 03814 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 03815 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2)) 03816 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03817 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1)) 03818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03819 } 03820 03821 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 03822 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 03823 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 03824 // reference of type A&, 03825 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 03826 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 03827 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1)) 03828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 03829 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2)) 03830 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 03831 } 03832 } 03833 03834 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 03835 } 03836 03837 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 03838 /// determine whether they are reference-related, 03839 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added 03840 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 03841 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 03842 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 03843 /// type being initialized. 03844 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 03845 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 03846 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 03847 bool &DerivedToBase, 03848 bool &ObjCConversion, 03849 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 03850 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 03851 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 03852 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 03853 03854 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 03855 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 03856 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 03857 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 03858 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 03859 03860 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 03861 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 03862 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or 03863 // T1 is a base class of T2. 03864 DerivedToBase = false; 03865 ObjCConversion = false; 03866 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 03867 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 03868 // Nothing to do. 03869 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) && 03870 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 03871 DerivedToBase = true; 03872 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 03873 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 03874 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 03875 ObjCConversion = true; 03876 else 03877 return Ref_Incompatible; 03878 03879 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at 03880 // least). 03881 03882 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 03883 // for comparison. 03884 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 03885 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 03886 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 03887 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 03888 03889 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 03890 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is 03891 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification 03892 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of 03893 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater 03894 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as 03895 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2). 03896 // 03897 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space 03898 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in 03899 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address 03900 // space 2. 03901 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() && 03902 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) { 03903 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 03904 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 03905 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 03906 } 03907 03908 if (T1Quals == T2Quals) 03909 return Ref_Compatible; 03910 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 03911 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification; 03912 else 03913 return Ref_Related; 03914 } 03915 03916 /// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible 03917 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 03918 static bool 03919 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 03920 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 03921 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 03922 bool AllowExplicit) { 03923 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 03924 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl 03925 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 03926 03927 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc); 03928 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 03929 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 03930 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 03931 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 03932 NamedDecl *D = *I; 03933 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 03934 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 03935 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 03936 03937 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 03938 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 03939 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 03940 if (ConvTemplate) 03941 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 03942 else 03943 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 03944 03945 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider 03946 // explicit conversions, skip it. 03947 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit()) 03948 continue; 03949 03950 if (AllowRvalues) { 03951 bool DerivedToBase = false; 03952 bool ObjCConversion = false; 03953 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 03954 03955 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 03956 // functions that return lvalues. 03957 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 03958 const ReferenceType *RefType 03959 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 03960 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 03961 continue; 03962 } 03963 03964 if (!ConvTemplate && 03965 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 03966 DeclLoc, 03967 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType() 03968 .getUnqualifiedType(), 03969 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 03970 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) == 03971 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 03972 continue; 03973 } else { 03974 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 03975 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 03976 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 03977 03978 const ReferenceType *RefType = 03979 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 03980 if (!RefType || 03981 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 03982 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 03983 continue; 03984 } 03985 03986 if (ConvTemplate) 03987 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, 03988 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet); 03989 else 03990 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, 03991 DeclType, CandidateSet); 03992 } 03993 03994 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 03995 03996 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 03997 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) { 03998 case OR_Success: 03999 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 04000 // 04001 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 04002 // applying a conversion function to the argument 04003 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 04004 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 04005 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 04006 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 04007 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 04008 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 04009 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 04010 return false; 04011 04012 if (Best->Function) 04013 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function); 04014 ICS.setUserDefined(); 04015 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 04016 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 04017 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 04018 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 04019 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 04020 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 04021 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 04022 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 04023 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 04024 return true; 04025 04026 case OR_Ambiguous: 04027 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 04028 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 04029 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 04030 if (Cand->Viable) 04031 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function); 04032 return true; 04033 04034 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 04035 case OR_Deleted: 04036 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 04037 // conversion; continue with other checks. 04038 return false; 04039 } 04040 04041 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 04042 } 04043 04044 /// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 04045 /// initialization. 04046 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04047 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 04048 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 04049 bool SuppressUserConversions, 04050 bool AllowExplicit) { 04051 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 04052 04053 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 04054 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 04055 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 04056 04057 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 04058 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 04059 04060 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 04061 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 04062 // type of the resulting function. 04063 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 04064 DeclAccessPair Found; 04065 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 04066 false, Found)) 04067 T2 = Fn->getType(); 04068 } 04069 04070 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 04071 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 04072 bool DerivedToBase = false; 04073 bool ObjCConversion = false; 04074 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 04075 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 04076 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 04077 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase, 04078 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion); 04079 04080 04081 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 04082 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 04083 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 04084 04085 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 04086 if (!isRValRef) { 04087 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 04088 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 04089 // 04090 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 04091 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && 04092 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) { 04093 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 04094 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 04095 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 04096 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 04097 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 04098 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 04099 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 04100 ICS.setStandard(); 04101 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 04102 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 04103 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 04104 : ICK_Identity; 04105 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 04106 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 04107 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 04108 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 04109 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 04110 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 04111 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 04112 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 04113 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 04114 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false; 04115 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 04116 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 04117 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 04118 04119 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 04120 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 04121 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 04122 // [over.best.ics]p2). 04123 return ICS; 04124 } 04125 04126 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 04127 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 04128 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 04129 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 04130 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 04131 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 04132 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 04133 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 04134 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 04135 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 04136 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 04137 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 04138 AllowExplicit)) 04139 return ICS; 04140 } 04141 } 04142 04143 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 04144 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 04145 // shall be an rvalue reference. 04146 // 04147 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this 04148 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference 04149 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct 04150 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile 04151 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence 04152 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only 04153 // qualifier. 04154 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer 04155 // go together. 04156 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified()) 04157 return ICS; 04158 04159 // -- If the initializer expression 04160 // 04161 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 04162 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 04163 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification && 04164 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 04165 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 04166 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 04167 ICS.setStandard(); 04168 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 04169 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 04170 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 04171 : ICK_Identity; 04172 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 04173 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 04174 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 04175 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 04176 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 04177 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 04178 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 04179 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 04180 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 04181 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 04182 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 04183 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = 04184 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus0x || 04185 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType()); 04186 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 04187 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 04188 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 04189 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 04190 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 04191 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0; 04192 return ICS; 04193 } 04194 04195 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 04196 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 04197 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 04198 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 04199 // "cv3 T3", 04200 // 04201 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 04202 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 04203 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 04204 // class subobject). 04205 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 04206 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) && 04207 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 04208 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 04209 AllowExplicit)) { 04210 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 04211 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 04212 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 04213 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 04214 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 04215 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 04216 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 04217 04218 return ICS; 04219 } 04220 04221 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 04222 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 04223 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 04224 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 04225 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 04226 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 04227 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 04228 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 04229 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 04230 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 04231 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 04232 // initialization fails. 04233 // 04234 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 04235 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important. 04236 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 04237 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 04238 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 04239 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 04240 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 04241 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 04242 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 04243 return ICS; 04244 } 04245 04246 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 04247 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 04248 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 04249 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 04250 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 04251 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 04252 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 04253 return ICS; 04254 04255 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 04256 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 04257 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 04258 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 04259 return ICS; 04260 04261 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 04262 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 04263 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 04264 // required to convert the argument expression to the 04265 // underlying type of the reference according to 04266 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 04267 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 04268 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 04269 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 04270 // and does not constitute a conversion. 04271 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 04272 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 04273 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 04274 /*CStyle=*/false, 04275 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 04276 04277 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 04278 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 04279 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 04280 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 04281 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 04282 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 04283 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 04284 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 04285 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 04286 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues. 04287 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 04288 if (const ReferenceType *RefType 04289 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType() 04290 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 04291 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) { 04292 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, 04293 DeclType); 04294 return ICS; 04295 } 04296 } 04297 } 04298 04299 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 04300 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 04301 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 04302 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true; 04303 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 04304 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 04305 } 04306 04307 return ICS; 04308 } 04309 04310 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04311 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 04312 bool SuppressUserConversions, 04313 bool InOverloadResolution, 04314 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 04315 bool AllowExplicit = false); 04316 04317 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 04318 /// initializer list From. 04319 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04320 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 04321 bool SuppressUserConversions, 04322 bool InOverloadResolution, 04323 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 04324 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 04325 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 04326 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 04327 04328 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 04329 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 04330 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 04331 04332 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 04333 // initialized from init lists. 04334 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0)) 04335 return Result; 04336 04337 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 04338 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 04339 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 04340 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 04341 // element of the list to X. 04342 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 04343 QualType X; 04344 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 04345 X = S.Context.getBaseElementType(ToType); 04346 else 04347 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 04348 if (!X.isNull()) { 04349 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 04350 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 04351 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 04352 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 04353 InOverloadResolution, 04354 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 04355 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 04356 if (ICS.isBad()) { 04357 Result = ICS; 04358 break; 04359 } 04360 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 04361 if (Result.isBad() || 04362 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) == 04363 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 04364 Result = ICS; 04365 } 04366 04367 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 04368 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 04369 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 04370 Result.setStandard(); 04371 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 04372 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 04373 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 04374 } 04375 04376 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 04377 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 04378 return Result; 04379 } 04380 04381 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 04382 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 04383 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 04384 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 04385 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 04386 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 04387 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 04388 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 04389 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 04390 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 04391 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 04392 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 04393 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 04394 return Result; 04395 } 04396 04397 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 04398 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 04399 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 04400 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 04401 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 04402 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 04403 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 04404 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 04405 InitializedEntity Entity = 04406 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 04407 /*Consumed=*/false); 04408 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) { 04409 Result.setUserDefined(); 04410 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 04411 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 04412 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 04413 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 04414 04415 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 04416 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 04417 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 04418 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0; 04419 } 04420 return Result; 04421 } 04422 04423 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 04424 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 04425 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 04426 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 04427 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 04428 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 04429 04430 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 04431 04432 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 04433 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 04434 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 04435 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 04436 04437 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 04438 04439 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 04440 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 04441 // type of the resulting function. 04442 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 04443 DeclAccessPair Found; 04444 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 04445 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 04446 T2 = Fn->getType(); 04447 } 04448 04449 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 04450 bool dummy1 = false; 04451 bool dummy2 = false; 04452 bool dummy3 = false; 04453 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 04454 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1, 04455 dummy2, dummy3); 04456 04457 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) 04458 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, 04459 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 04460 SuppressUserConversions, 04461 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 04462 } 04463 04464 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 04465 // initializer list. 04466 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 04467 InOverloadResolution, 04468 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 04469 if (Result.isFailure()) 04470 return Result; 04471 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 04472 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 04473 04474 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 04475 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 04476 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 04477 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 04478 Result.UserDefined.After; 04479 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 04480 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 04481 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 04482 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 04483 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 04484 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 04485 } else 04486 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 04487 From, ToType); 04488 return Result; 04489 } 04490 04491 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 04492 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 04493 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 04494 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion 04495 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the 04496 // parameter type. 04497 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 04498 if (NumInits == 1) 04499 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 04500 SuppressUserConversions, 04501 InOverloadResolution, 04502 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 04503 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 04504 // sequence is the identity conversion. 04505 else if (NumInits == 0) { 04506 Result.setStandard(); 04507 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 04508 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 04509 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 04510 } 04511 Result.setListInitializationSequence(); 04512 return Result; 04513 } 04514 04515 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 04516 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 04517 return Result; 04518 } 04519 04520 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 04521 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 04522 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 04523 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 04524 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 04525 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 04526 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04527 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 04528 bool SuppressUserConversions, 04529 bool InOverloadResolution, 04530 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 04531 bool AllowExplicit) { 04532 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 04533 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 04534 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 04535 04536 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 04537 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 04538 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 04539 SuppressUserConversions, 04540 AllowExplicit); 04541 04542 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 04543 SuppressUserConversions, 04544 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 04545 InOverloadResolution, 04546 /*CStyle=*/false, 04547 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 04548 } 04549 04550 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 04551 const CanQualType ToQTy, 04552 Sema &S, 04553 SourceLocation Loc, 04554 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 04555 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 04556 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 04557 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 04558 04559 return !ICS.isBad(); 04560 } 04561 04562 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 04563 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 04564 /// expression @p From. 04565 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04566 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType, 04567 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 04568 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 04569 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 04570 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 04571 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 04572 // const volatile object. 04573 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ? 04574 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers(); 04575 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 04576 04577 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 04578 // to exit early. 04579 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 04580 04581 // We need to have an object of class type. 04582 QualType FromType = OrigFromType; 04583 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 04584 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 04585 04586 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 04587 // better have an lvalue. 04588 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 04589 } 04590 04591 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 04592 04593 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 04594 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 04595 // parameter is 04596 // 04597 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 04598 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 04599 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 04600 // ref-qualifier 04601 // 04602 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 04603 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 04604 // 04605 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 04606 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions 04607 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 04608 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 04609 // non-constant references. 04610 04611 // First check the qualifiers. 04612 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 04613 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 04614 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 04615 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 04616 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 04617 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType); 04618 return ICS; 04619 } 04620 04621 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 04622 // affects the conversion rank. 04623 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 04624 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 04625 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 04626 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 04627 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType)) 04628 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 04629 else { 04630 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 04631 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 04632 return ICS; 04633 } 04634 04635 // Check the ref-qualifier. 04636 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 04637 case RQ_None: 04638 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 04639 break; 04640 04641 case RQ_LValue: 04642 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) { 04643 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 04644 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 04645 ImplicitParamType); 04646 return ICS; 04647 } 04648 break; 04649 04650 case RQ_RValue: 04651 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 04652 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 04653 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 04654 ImplicitParamType); 04655 return ICS; 04656 } 04657 break; 04658 } 04659 04660 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 04661 ICS.setStandard(); 04662 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 04663 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 04664 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 04665 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 04666 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 04667 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 04668 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 04669 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 04670 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 04671 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 04672 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 04673 return ICS; 04674 } 04675 04676 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 04677 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 04678 /// expression. 04679 ExprResult 04680 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 04681 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 04682 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 04683 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 04684 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 04685 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 04686 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 04687 04688 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 04689 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 04690 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 04691 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 04692 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 04693 } else { 04694 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 04695 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 04696 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 04697 } 04698 04699 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 04700 // the actual argument initialization. 04701 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 04702 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification, 04703 Method, Method->getParent()); 04704 if (ICS.isBad()) { 04705 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) { 04706 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 04707 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 04708 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 04709 if (CVR) { 04710 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04711 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 04712 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 04713 << From->getSourceRange(); 04714 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 04715 << Method->getDeclName(); 04716 return ExprError(); 04717 } 04718 } 04719 04720 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04721 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init) 04722 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange(); 04723 } 04724 04725 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 04726 ExprResult FromRes = 04727 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 04728 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 04729 return ExprError(); 04730 From = FromRes.take(); 04731 } 04732 04733 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) 04734 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp, 04735 From->getValueKind()).take(); 04736 return Owned(From); 04737 } 04738 04739 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 04740 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 04741 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04742 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 04743 // FIXME: This is pretty broken. 04744 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 04745 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 04746 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 04747 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 04748 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 04749 /*CStyle=*/false, 04750 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 04751 } 04752 04753 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 04754 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 04755 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 04756 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 04757 return ExprError(); 04758 04759 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 04760 if (!ICS.isBad()) 04761 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 04762 04763 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 04764 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04765 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 04766 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 04767 return ExprError(); 04768 } 04769 04770 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 04771 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 04772 /// is acceptable. 04773 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 04774 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 04775 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 04776 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 04777 // conversions are fine. 04778 switch (SCS.Second) { 04779 case ICK_Identity: 04780 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 04781 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 04782 return true; 04783 04784 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 04785 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 04786 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral 04787 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression. 04788 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 04789 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 04790 04791 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 04792 case ICK_Complex_Real: 04793 return false; 04794 04795 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 04796 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 04797 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 04798 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment: 04799 case ICK_Qualification: 04800 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 04801 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 04802 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 04803 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 04804 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 04805 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 04806 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 04807 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 04808 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 04809 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 04810 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 04811 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 04812 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 04813 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind"); 04814 04815 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 04816 break; 04817 } 04818 04819 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 04820 } 04821 04822 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 04823 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 04824 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 04825 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 04826 llvm::APSInt &Value, 04827 CCEKind CCE) { 04828 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus0x && "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 04829 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 04830 04831 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 04832 return ExprError(); 04833 04834 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes: 04835 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression, 04836 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted 04837 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion 04838 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue 04839 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than 04840 // narrowing conversions. 04841 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 04842 TryImplicitConversion(From, T, 04843 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 04844 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 04845 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 04846 /*CStyle=*/false, 04847 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false); 04848 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0; 04849 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 04850 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 04851 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard)) 04852 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04853 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 04854 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 04855 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 04856 break; 04857 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 04858 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so 04859 // the Before sequence must be trivial. 04860 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After)) 04861 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04862 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 04863 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 04864 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 04865 break; 04866 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 04867 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 04868 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 04869 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04870 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 04871 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 04872 return ExprError(); 04873 04874 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 04875 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 04876 } 04877 04878 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting); 04879 if (Result.isInvalid()) 04880 return Result; 04881 04882 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 04883 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 04884 QualType PreNarrowingType; 04885 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 04886 PreNarrowingType)) { 04887 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 04888 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 04889 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 04890 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 04891 break; 04892 04893 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 04894 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04895 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae : 04896 diag::err_cce_narrowing) 04897 << CCE << /*Constant*/1 04898 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 04899 break; 04900 04901 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 04902 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 04903 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae : 04904 diag::err_cce_narrowing) 04905 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T; 04906 break; 04907 } 04908 04909 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 04910 llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 04911 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 04912 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 04913 04914 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) { 04915 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 04916 // the AST. 04917 Result = ExprError(); 04918 } else { 04919 Value = Eval.Val.getInt(); 04920 04921 if (Notes.empty()) { 04922 // It's a constant expression. 04923 return Result; 04924 } 04925 } 04926 04927 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 04928 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 04929 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 04930 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 04931 else { 04932 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 04933 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 04934 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 04935 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 04936 } 04937 return Result; 04938 } 04939 04940 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 04941 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 04942 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 04943 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 04944 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 04945 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 04946 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 04947 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 04948 } 04949 } 04950 04951 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 04952 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 04953 static ImplicitConversionSequence 04954 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 04955 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 04956 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 04957 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 04958 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 04959 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 04960 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 04961 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 04962 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 04963 /*CStyle=*/false, 04964 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 04965 04966 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 04967 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 04968 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 04969 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 04970 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 04971 break; 04972 04973 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 04974 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 04975 break; 04976 04977 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 04978 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 04979 break; 04980 } 04981 04982 return ICS; 04983 } 04984 04985 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 04986 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 04987 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 04988 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 04989 return ExprError(); 04990 04991 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 04992 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 04993 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 04994 if (!ICS.isBad()) 04995 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 04996 return ExprError(); 04997 } 04998 04999 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 05000 /// type of a permitted flavor. 05001 static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) { 05002 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 05003 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 05004 } 05005 05006 /// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or 05007 /// enumeration type. 05008 /// 05009 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an 05010 /// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single 05011 /// conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 05012 /// 05013 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 05014 /// conversion. 05015 /// 05016 /// \param FromE The expression we're converting from. 05017 /// 05018 /// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not 05019 /// have integral or enumeration type. 05020 /// 05021 /// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has 05022 /// incomplete class type. 05023 /// 05024 /// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an 05025 /// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions 05026 /// were available). This is a recovery mode. 05027 /// 05028 /// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag, 05029 /// showing which conversion was picked. 05030 /// 05031 /// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one 05032 /// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type. 05033 /// 05034 /// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each 05035 /// usable conversion function. 05036 /// 05037 /// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion 05038 /// function, which may be an extension in this case. 05039 /// 05040 /// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped 05041 /// enumerations should be considered. 05042 /// 05043 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 05044 /// successful. 05045 ExprResult 05046 Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 05047 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 05048 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) { 05049 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 05050 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 05051 return Owned(From); 05052 05053 // Process placeholders immediately. 05054 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 05055 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 05056 if (result.isInvalid()) return result; 05057 From = result.take(); 05058 } 05059 05060 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden. 05061 QualType T = From->getType(); 05062 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations)) 05063 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 05064 05065 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 05066 05067 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an 05068 // expression of integral or enumeration type. 05069 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 05070 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 05071 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 05072 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 05073 return Owned(From); 05074 } 05075 05076 // We must have a complete class type. 05077 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 05078 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser; 05079 Expr *From; 05080 05081 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, Expr *From) 05082 : TypeDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress), Diagnoser(Diagnoser), From(From) {} 05083 05084 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 05085 Diagnoser.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 05086 } 05087 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Diagnoser, From); 05088 05089 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 05090 return Owned(From); 05091 05092 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 05093 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions; 05094 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 05095 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 05096 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 05097 05098 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1); 05099 05100 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 05101 E = Conversions->end(); 05102 I != E; 05103 ++I) { 05104 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 05105 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) { 05106 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType( 05107 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(), 05108 AllowScopedEnumerations)) { 05109 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) 05110 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 05111 else 05112 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 05113 } 05114 } 05115 } 05116 05117 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 05118 case 0: 05119 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Diagnoser.Suppress) { 05120 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 05121 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 05122 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 05123 05124 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 05125 // conversion; use it. 05126 QualType ConvTy 05127 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 05128 std::string TypeStr; 05129 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy()); 05130 05131 Diagnoser.diagnoseExplicitConv(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy) 05132 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(), 05133 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 05134 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), 05135 ")"); 05136 Diagnoser.noteExplicitConv(*this, Conversion, ConvTy); 05137 05138 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 05139 // explicit conversion function. 05140 if (isSFINAEContext()) 05141 return ExprError(); 05142 05143 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found); 05144 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 05145 HadMultipleCandidates); 05146 if (Result.isInvalid()) 05147 return ExprError(); 05148 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 05149 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(), 05150 CK_UserDefinedConversion, 05151 Result.get(), 0, 05152 Result.get()->getValueKind()); 05153 } 05154 05155 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 05156 break; 05157 05158 case 1: { 05159 // Apply this conversion. 05160 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 05161 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found); 05162 05163 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 05164 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 05165 QualType ConvTy 05166 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 05167 if (!Diagnoser.SuppressConversion) { 05168 if (isSFINAEContext()) 05169 return ExprError(); 05170 05171 Diagnoser.diagnoseConversion(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy) 05172 << From->getSourceRange(); 05173 } 05174 05175 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 05176 HadMultipleCandidates); 05177 if (Result.isInvalid()) 05178 return ExprError(); 05179 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 05180 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(), 05181 CK_UserDefinedConversion, 05182 Result.get(), 0, 05183 Result.get()->getValueKind()); 05184 break; 05185 } 05186 05187 default: 05188 if (Diagnoser.Suppress) 05189 return ExprError(); 05190 05191 Diagnoser.diagnoseAmbiguous(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 05192 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 05193 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 05194 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 05195 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 05196 Diagnoser.noteAmbiguous(*this, Conv, ConvTy); 05197 } 05198 return Owned(From); 05199 } 05200 05201 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) && 05202 !Diagnoser.Suppress) { 05203 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, From->getType()) 05204 << From->getSourceRange(); 05205 } 05206 05207 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 05208 } 05209 05210 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 05211 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 05212 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 05213 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 05214 /// 05215 /// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 05216 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 05217 /// code completion. 05218 void 05219 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, 05220 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05221 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 05222 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05223 bool SuppressUserConversions, 05224 bool PartialOverloading, 05225 bool AllowExplicit) { 05226 const FunctionProtoType* Proto 05227 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 05228 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 05229 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 05230 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 05231 05232 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 05233 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 05234 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 05235 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 05236 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 05237 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 05238 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 05239 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 05240 // is irrelevant. 05241 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), 05242 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), 05243 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 05244 return; 05245 } 05246 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 05247 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 05248 } 05249 05250 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function)) 05251 return; 05252 05253 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 05254 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 05255 05256 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){ 05257 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 05258 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 05259 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 05260 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 05261 if (Args.size() == 1 && 05262 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 05263 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 05264 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType))) 05265 return; 05266 } 05267 05268 // Add this candidate 05269 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 05270 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05271 Candidate.Function = Function; 05272 Candidate.Viable = true; 05273 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05274 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05275 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 05276 05277 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 05278 05279 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 05280 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 05281 // list (8.3.5). 05282 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto && 05283 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 05284 Candidate.Viable = false; 05285 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 05286 return; 05287 } 05288 05289 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 05290 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 05291 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 05292 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 05293 // exactly m parameters. 05294 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 05295 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 05296 // Not enough arguments. 05297 Candidate.Viable = false; 05298 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 05299 return; 05300 } 05301 05302 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 05303 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 05304 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 05305 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) { 05306 Candidate.Viable = false; 05307 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 05308 return; 05309 } 05310 05311 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 05312 // arguments. 05313 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 05314 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 05315 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 05316 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 05317 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 05318 // parameter of F. 05319 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 05320 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 05321 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 05322 SuppressUserConversions, 05323 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 05324 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 05325 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 05326 AllowExplicit); 05327 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 05328 Candidate.Viable = false; 05329 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 05330 break; 05331 } 05332 } else { 05333 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 05334 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 05335 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 05336 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis(); 05337 } 05338 } 05339 } 05340 05341 /// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 05342 /// the overload canddiate set. 05343 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 05344 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 05345 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05346 bool SuppressUserConversions, 05347 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 05348 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 05349 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 05350 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 05351 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) 05352 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 05353 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), 05354 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context), 05355 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet, 05356 SuppressUserConversions); 05357 else 05358 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet, 05359 SuppressUserConversions); 05360 } else { 05361 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 05362 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) && 05363 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic()) 05364 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 05365 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 05366 ExplicitTemplateArgs, 05367 Args[0]->getType(), 05368 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 05369 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 05370 else 05371 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 05372 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 05373 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 05374 } 05375 } 05376 } 05377 05378 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 05379 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 05380 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05381 QualType ObjectType, 05382 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 05383 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 05384 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05385 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 05386 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 05387 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 05388 05389 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 05390 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 05391 05392 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 05393 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 05394 "Expected a member function template"); 05395 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 05396 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0, 05397 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 05398 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet, 05399 SuppressUserConversions); 05400 } else { 05401 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 05402 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 05403 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 05404 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 05405 } 05406 } 05407 05408 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 05409 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 05410 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 05411 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 05412 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 05413 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 05414 /// operators. 05415 void 05416 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05417 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 05418 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 05419 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 05420 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05421 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 05422 const FunctionProtoType* Proto 05423 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 05424 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 05425 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 05426 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 05427 05428 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method)) 05429 return; 05430 05431 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 05432 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 05433 05434 // Add this candidate 05435 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 05436 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05437 Candidate.Function = Method; 05438 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05439 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05440 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 05441 05442 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 05443 05444 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 05445 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 05446 // list (8.3.5). 05447 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 05448 Candidate.Viable = false; 05449 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 05450 return; 05451 } 05452 05453 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 05454 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 05455 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 05456 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 05457 // exactly m parameters. 05458 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 05459 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) { 05460 // Not enough arguments. 05461 Candidate.Viable = false; 05462 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 05463 return; 05464 } 05465 05466 Candidate.Viable = true; 05467 05468 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 05469 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 05470 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 05471 else { 05472 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 05473 // parameter. 05474 Candidate.Conversions[0] 05475 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 05476 Method, ActingContext); 05477 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 05478 Candidate.Viable = false; 05479 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 05480 return; 05481 } 05482 } 05483 05484 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 05485 // arguments. 05486 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 05487 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 05488 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 05489 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 05490 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 05491 // parameter of F. 05492 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 05493 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 05494 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 05495 SuppressUserConversions, 05496 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 05497 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 05498 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 05499 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 05500 Candidate.Viable = false; 05501 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 05502 break; 05503 } 05504 } else { 05505 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 05506 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 05507 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 05508 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 05509 } 05510 } 05511 } 05512 05513 /// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 05514 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 05515 /// function template specialization. 05516 void 05517 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, 05518 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05519 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 05520 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 05521 QualType ObjectType, 05522 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 05523 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 05524 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05525 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 05526 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl)) 05527 return; 05528 05529 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 05530 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 05531 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 05532 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 05533 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 05534 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 05535 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 05536 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 05537 // functions. 05538 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 05539 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 05540 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 05541 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 05542 Specialization, Info)) { 05543 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 05544 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05545 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 05546 Candidate.Viable = false; 05547 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 05548 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05549 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05550 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 05551 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 05552 Info); 05553 return; 05554 } 05555 05556 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 05557 // deduction as a candidate. 05558 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 05559 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 05560 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 05561 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 05562 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 05563 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 05564 } 05565 05566 /// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 05567 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 05568 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 05569 void 05570 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 05571 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05572 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 05573 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 05574 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05575 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 05576 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 05577 return; 05578 05579 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 05580 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 05581 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 05582 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 05583 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 05584 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 05585 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 05586 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 05587 // functions. 05588 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 05589 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 05590 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 05591 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 05592 Specialization, Info)) { 05593 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 05594 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05595 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 05596 Candidate.Viable = false; 05597 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 05598 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05599 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05600 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 05601 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 05602 Info); 05603 return; 05604 } 05605 05606 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 05607 // deduction as a candidate. 05608 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 05609 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 05610 SuppressUserConversions); 05611 } 05612 05613 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 05614 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 05615 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 05616 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 05617 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 05618 /// conversion function produces). 05619 void 05620 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 05621 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05622 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 05623 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 05624 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 05625 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 05626 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 05627 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 05628 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 05629 return; 05630 05631 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 05632 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 05633 05634 // Add this candidate 05635 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 05636 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05637 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 05638 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05639 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05640 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 05641 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 05642 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 05643 Candidate.Viable = true; 05644 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 05645 05646 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 05647 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 05648 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 05649 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 05650 // 05651 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 05652 // object parameter. 05653 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 05654 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 05655 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 05656 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 05657 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 05658 05659 Candidate.Conversions[0] 05660 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), 05661 From->Classify(Context), 05662 Conversion, ConversionContext); 05663 05664 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 05665 Candidate.Viable = false; 05666 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 05667 return; 05668 } 05669 05670 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a 05671 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 05672 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 05673 QualType FromCanon 05674 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 05675 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 05676 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 05677 Candidate.Viable = false; 05678 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 05679 return; 05680 } 05681 05682 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 05683 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 05684 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 05685 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 05686 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 05687 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 05688 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 05689 // well-formed. 05690 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 05691 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart()); 05692 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 05693 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 05694 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 05695 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 05696 05697 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 05698 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) { 05699 Candidate.Viable = false; 05700 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 05701 return; 05702 } 05703 05704 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 05705 05706 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 05707 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 05708 // allocator). 05709 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 05710 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK, 05711 From->getLocStart()); 05712 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 05713 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType, 05714 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 05715 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 05716 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 05717 05718 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 05719 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 05720 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 05721 05722 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 05723 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 05724 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 05725 // shall have exact match rank. 05726 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 05727 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 05728 Candidate.Viable = false; 05729 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 05730 } 05731 05732 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 05733 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 05734 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 05735 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 05736 // program is ill-formed. 05737 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 05738 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 05739 Candidate.Viable = false; 05740 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 05741 } 05742 break; 05743 05744 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 05745 Candidate.Viable = false; 05746 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 05747 break; 05748 05749 default: 05750 llvm_unreachable( 05751 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 05752 } 05753 } 05754 05755 /// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization 05756 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 05757 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 05758 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 05759 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 05760 void 05761 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 05762 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05763 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, 05764 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 05765 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 05766 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 05767 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 05768 05769 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 05770 return; 05771 05772 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation()); 05773 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0; 05774 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 05775 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 05776 Specialization, Info)) { 05777 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 05778 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05779 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 05780 Candidate.Viable = false; 05781 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 05782 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05783 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05784 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 05785 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 05786 Info); 05787 return; 05788 } 05789 05790 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 05791 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 05792 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 05793 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 05794 CandidateSet); 05795 } 05796 05797 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 05798 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 05799 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 05800 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 05801 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 05802 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 05803 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 05804 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 05805 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 05806 Expr *Object, 05807 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 05808 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 05809 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 05810 return; 05811 05812 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 05813 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 05814 05815 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 05816 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 05817 Candidate.Function = 0; 05818 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 05819 Candidate.Viable = true; 05820 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 05821 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05822 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 05823 05824 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 05825 // object parameter. 05826 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit 05827 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(), 05828 Object->Classify(Context), 05829 Conversion, ActingContext); 05830 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 05831 Candidate.Viable = false; 05832 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 05833 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 05834 return; 05835 } 05836 05837 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 05838 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 05839 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 05840 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 05841 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 05842 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 05843 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 05844 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 05845 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 05846 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 05847 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 05848 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 05849 05850 // Find the 05851 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 05852 05853 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 05854 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 05855 // list (8.3.5). 05856 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 05857 Candidate.Viable = false; 05858 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 05859 return; 05860 } 05861 05862 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 05863 // we have enough arguments. 05864 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) { 05865 // Not enough arguments. 05866 Candidate.Viable = false; 05867 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 05868 return; 05869 } 05870 05871 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 05872 // arguments. 05873 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 05874 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 05875 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 05876 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 05877 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 05878 // parameter of F. 05879 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx); 05880 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 05881 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 05882 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 05883 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 05884 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 05885 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 05886 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 05887 Candidate.Viable = false; 05888 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 05889 break; 05890 } 05891 } else { 05892 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 05893 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 05894 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 05895 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 05896 } 05897 } 05898 } 05899 05900 /// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 05901 /// member functions. 05902 /// 05903 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 05904 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 05905 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 05906 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 05907 /// [over.match.oper]). 05908 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 05909 SourceLocation OpLoc, 05910 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 05911 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05912 SourceRange OpRange) { 05913 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 05914 05915 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 05916 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 05917 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 05918 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 05919 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 05920 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 05921 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 05922 // constructed as follows: 05923 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 05924 05925 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the 05926 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@ 05927 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is 05928 // empty. 05929 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 05930 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done. 05931 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0)) 05932 return; 05933 05934 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 05935 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 05936 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 05937 05938 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 05939 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 05940 Oper != OperEnd; 05941 ++Oper) 05942 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 05943 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, 05944 CandidateSet, 05945 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false); 05946 } 05947 } 05948 05949 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 05950 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 05951 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 05952 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 05953 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 05954 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 05955 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 05956 /// converted to bool. 05957 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys, 05958 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 05959 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 05960 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 05961 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 05962 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 05963 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated); 05964 05965 // Add this candidate 05966 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs); 05967 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none); 05968 Candidate.Function = 0; 05969 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 05970 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 05971 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy; 05972 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 05973 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx]; 05974 05975 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 05976 // arguments. 05977 Candidate.Viable = true; 05978 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs; 05979 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 05980 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 05981 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 05982 // left operand are restricted as follows: 05983 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 05984 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 05985 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 05986 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 05987 // 05988 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 05989 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 05990 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 05991 // is not of the same type. 05992 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 05993 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 05994 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 05995 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 05996 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 05997 } else { 05998 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 05999 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 06000 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 06001 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 06002 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 06003 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 06004 } 06005 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 06006 Candidate.Viable = false; 06007 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 06008 break; 06009 } 06010 } 06011 } 06012 06013 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 06014 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 06015 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 06016 /// enumeration types. 06017 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 06018 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 06019 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet; 06020 06021 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 06022 /// built-in candidates. 06023 TypeSet PointerTypes; 06024 06025 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 06026 /// used in the built-in candidates. 06027 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 06028 06029 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 06030 /// used in the built-in candidates. 06031 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 06032 06033 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 06034 /// candidates. 06035 TypeSet VectorTypes; 06036 06037 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 06038 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 06039 06040 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 06041 /// were present in the candidate set. 06042 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 06043 06044 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 06045 /// candidate set. 06046 bool HasNullPtrType; 06047 06048 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 06049 /// candidate type set. 06050 Sema &SemaRef; 06051 06052 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 06053 ASTContext &Context; 06054 06055 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 06056 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 06057 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 06058 06059 public: 06060 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 06061 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 06062 06063 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 06064 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 06065 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 06066 HasNullPtrType(false), 06067 SemaRef(SemaRef), 06068 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 06069 06070 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 06071 SourceLocation Loc, 06072 bool AllowUserConversions, 06073 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 06074 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 06075 06076 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 06077 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 06078 06079 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 06080 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 06081 06082 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 06083 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 06084 06085 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 06086 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 06087 06088 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 06089 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 06090 06091 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 06092 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 06093 06094 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 06095 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 06096 06097 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 06098 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 06099 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 06100 }; 06101 06102 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 06103 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 06104 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 06105 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 06106 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 06107 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 06108 /// false otherwise. 06109 /// 06110 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 06111 bool 06112 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 06113 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 06114 06115 // Insert this type. 06116 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 06117 return false; 06118 06119 QualType PointeeTy; 06120 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 06121 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 06122 if (!PointerTy) { 06123 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 06124 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 06125 buildObjCPtr = true; 06126 } 06127 else 06128 llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!"); 06129 } 06130 else 06131 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 06132 06133 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 06134 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 06135 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 06136 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 06137 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 06138 return true; 06139 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 06140 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy)) 06141 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers(); 06142 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 06143 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 06144 06145 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 06146 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 06147 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 06148 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere 06149 // in the types. 06150 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 06151 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue; 06152 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 06153 if (!buildObjCPtr) 06154 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy)); 06155 else 06156 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy)); 06157 } 06158 06159 return true; 06160 } 06161 06162 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 06163 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 06164 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 06165 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 06166 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 06167 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 06168 /// false otherwise. 06169 /// 06170 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 06171 bool 06172 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 06173 QualType Ty) { 06174 // Insert this type. 06175 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 06176 return false; 06177 06178 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 06179 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 06180 06181 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 06182 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 06183 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 06184 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 06185 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 06186 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 06187 return true; 06188 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 06189 06190 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 06191 // qualifiers. 06192 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 06193 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 06194 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 06195 06196 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 06197 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 06198 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 06199 } 06200 06201 return true; 06202 } 06203 06204 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 06205 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 06206 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 06207 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 06208 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 06209 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 06210 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 06211 /// type. 06212 void 06213 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 06214 SourceLocation Loc, 06215 bool AllowUserConversions, 06216 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 06217 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 06218 // Only deal with canonical types. 06219 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 06220 06221 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 06222 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 06223 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 06224 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 06225 06226 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 06227 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 06228 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 06229 06230 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 06231 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 06232 06233 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 06234 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 06235 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 06236 06237 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 06238 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 06239 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 06240 06241 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 06242 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 06243 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 06244 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 06245 // of types. 06246 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 06247 return; 06248 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 06249 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 06250 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 06251 return; 06252 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 06253 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 06254 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 06255 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 06256 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 06257 // extension. 06258 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 06259 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 06260 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 06261 HasNullPtrType = true; 06262 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 06263 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 06264 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0)) 06265 return; 06266 06267 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 06268 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 06269 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 06270 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 06271 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 06272 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl(); 06273 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 06274 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 06275 06276 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 06277 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 06278 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 06279 continue; 06280 06281 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 06282 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 06283 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 06284 VisibleQuals); 06285 } 06286 } 06287 } 06288 } 06289 06290 /// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 06291 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 06292 /// given type to the candidate set. 06293 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 06294 QualType T, 06295 Expr **Args, 06296 unsigned NumArgs, 06297 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 06298 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 06299 06300 // T& operator=(T&, T) 06301 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 06302 ParamTypes[1] = T; 06303 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 06304 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 06305 06306 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 06307 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 06308 ParamTypes[0] 06309 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T)); 06310 ParamTypes[1] = T; 06311 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 06312 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 06313 } 06314 } 06315 06316 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 06317 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 06318 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 06319 Qualifiers VRQuals; 06320 const RecordType *TyRec; 06321 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 06322 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 06323 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 06324 else 06325 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 06326 if (!TyRec) { 06327 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 06328 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 06329 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 06330 return VRQuals; 06331 } 06332 06333 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 06334 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 06335 return VRQuals; 06336 06337 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions = 06338 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 06339 06340 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 06341 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 06342 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl(); 06343 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 06344 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 06345 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 06346 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 06347 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 06348 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 06349 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 06350 // as see them. 06351 bool done = false; 06352 while (!done) { 06353 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 06354 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 06355 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 06356 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 06357 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 06358 else 06359 done = true; 06360 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 06361 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 06362 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 06363 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 06364 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 06365 return VRQuals; 06366 } 06367 } 06368 } 06369 return VRQuals; 06370 } 06371 06372 namespace { 06373 06374 /// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 06375 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 06376 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 06377 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 06378 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 06379 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 06380 Sema &S; 06381 Expr **Args; 06382 unsigned NumArgs; 06383 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 06384 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 06385 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 06386 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 06387 06388 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types 06389 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below. 06390 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 06391 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 06392 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3; 06393 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18; 06394 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3, 06395 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9; 06396 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0, 06397 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9; 06398 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18; 06399 06400 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index. 06401 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) { 06402 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes); 06403 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const 06404 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = { 06405 // Start of promoted types. 06406 &ASTContext::FloatTy, 06407 &ASTContext::DoubleTy, 06408 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy, 06409 06410 // Start of integral types. 06411 &ASTContext::IntTy, 06412 &ASTContext::LongTy, 06413 &ASTContext::LongLongTy, 06414 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy, 06415 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy, 06416 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy, 06417 // End of promoted types. 06418 06419 &ASTContext::BoolTy, 06420 &ASTContext::CharTy, 06421 &ASTContext::WCharTy, 06422 &ASTContext::Char16Ty, 06423 &ASTContext::Char32Ty, 06424 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy, 06425 &ASTContext::ShortTy, 06426 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy, 06427 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy, 06428 // End of integral types. 06429 // FIXME: What about complex? 06430 }; 06431 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index]; 06432 } 06433 06434 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic 06435 /// converions for the given arithmetic types. 06436 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) { 06437 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions. 06438 // The rules are basically: 06439 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point 06440 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank 06441 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank 06442 // - use the larger type 06443 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are 06444 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results 06445 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank. 06446 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's 06447 // better not to make any assumptions). 06448 enum PromotedType { 06449 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1 06450 }; 06451 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType] 06452 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = { 06453 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt }, 06454 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl }, 06455 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl }, 06456 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL }, 06457 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL }, 06458 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL }, 06459 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL }, 06460 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL }, 06461 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL }, 06462 }; 06463 06464 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 06465 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType); 06466 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R]; 06467 06468 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer. 06469 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx); 06470 06471 // Slow path: we need to compare widths. 06472 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank. 06473 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L), 06474 RT = getArithmeticType(R); 06475 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT), 06476 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT); 06477 06478 // If they're different widths, use the signed type. 06479 if (LW > RW) return LT; 06480 else if (LW < RW) return RT; 06481 06482 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank. 06483 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy; 06484 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL); 06485 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 06486 } 06487 06488 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 06489 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 06490 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 06491 bool HasVolatile) { 06492 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 06493 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 06494 S.Context.IntTy 06495 }; 06496 06497 // Non-volatile version. 06498 if (NumArgs == 1) 06499 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06500 else 06501 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 06502 06503 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 06504 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 06505 if (HasVolatile) { 06506 ParamTypes[0] = 06507 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 06508 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 06509 if (NumArgs == 1) 06510 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06511 else 06512 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 06513 } 06514 } 06515 06516 public: 06517 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 06518 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 06519 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 06520 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 06521 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 06522 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 06523 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs), 06524 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 06525 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 06526 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 06527 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 06528 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 06529 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds. 06530 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy && 06531 "Invalid first promoted integral type"); 06532 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1) 06533 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy && 06534 "Invalid last promoted integral type"); 06535 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType) 06536 == S.Context.FloatTy && 06537 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type"); 06538 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1) 06539 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy && 06540 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type"); 06541 } 06542 06543 // C++ [over.built]p3: 06544 // 06545 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ 06546 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator 06547 // functions of the form 06548 // 06549 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 06550 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 06551 // 06552 // C++ [over.built]p4: 06553 // 06554 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 06555 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 06556 // candidate operator functions of the form 06557 // 06558 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 06559 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 06560 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 06561 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 06562 return; 06563 06564 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1); 06565 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 06566 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 06567 getArithmeticType(Arith), 06568 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()); 06569 } 06570 } 06571 06572 // C++ [over.built]p5: 06573 // 06574 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 06575 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 06576 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 06577 // 06578 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 06579 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 06580 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 06581 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 06582 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 06583 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06584 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 06585 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 06586 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 06587 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 06588 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 06589 continue; 06590 06591 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 06592 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 06593 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile())); 06594 } 06595 } 06596 06597 // C++ [over.built]p6: 06598 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 06599 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 06600 // 06601 // T& operator*(T*); 06602 // 06603 // C++ [over.built]p7: 06604 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 06605 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 06606 // T& operator*(T*); 06607 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 06608 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06609 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 06610 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 06611 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 06612 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 06613 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 06614 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 06615 continue; 06616 06617 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 06618 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 06619 continue; 06620 06621 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy), 06622 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06623 } 06624 } 06625 06626 // C++ [over.built]p9: 06627 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 06628 // operator functions of the form 06629 // 06630 // T operator+(T); 06631 // T operator-(T); 06632 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 06633 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 06634 return; 06635 06636 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 06637 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 06638 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith); 06639 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06640 } 06641 06642 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 06643 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06644 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 06645 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 06646 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 06647 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 06648 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06649 } 06650 } 06651 06652 // C++ [over.built]p8: 06653 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 06654 // the form 06655 // 06656 // T* operator+(T*); 06657 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 06658 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06659 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 06660 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 06661 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 06662 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 06663 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06664 } 06665 } 06666 06667 // C++ [over.built]p10: 06668 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 06669 // operator functions of the form 06670 // 06671 // T operator~(T); 06672 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 06673 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 06674 return; 06675 06676 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 06677 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 06678 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int); 06679 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06680 } 06681 06682 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 06683 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06684 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 06685 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 06686 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 06687 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 06688 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet); 06689 } 06690 } 06691 06692 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 06693 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator 06694 // functions of the form 06695 // 06696 // bool operator==(T,T); 06697 // bool operator!=(T,T); 06698 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() { 06699 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 06700 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 06701 06702 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 06703 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06704 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 06705 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 06706 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 06707 ++MemPtr) { 06708 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 06709 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 06710 continue; 06711 06712 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 06713 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 06714 CandidateSet); 06715 } 06716 } 06717 } 06718 06719 // C++ [over.built]p15: 06720 // 06721 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or 06722 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 06723 // 06724 // bool operator<(T, T); 06725 // bool operator>(T, T); 06726 // bool operator<=(T, T); 06727 // bool operator>=(T, T); 06728 // bool operator==(T, T); 06729 // bool operator!=(T, T); 06730 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 06731 // C++ [over.built]p1: 06732 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter 06733 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator 06734 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate 06735 // functions. 06736 // 06737 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end 06738 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for 06739 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem, 06740 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the 06741 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=, 06742 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 06743 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 06744 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 06745 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 06746 06747 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 06748 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 06749 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 06750 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 06751 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 06752 C != CEnd; ++C) { 06753 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 06754 continue; 06755 06756 QualType FirstParamType = 06757 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 06758 QualType SecondParamType = 06759 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 06760 06761 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 06762 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 06763 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 06764 continue; 06765 06766 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 06767 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 06768 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 06769 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 06770 } 06771 } 06772 } 06773 06774 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 06775 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 06776 06777 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 06778 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06779 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 06780 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 06781 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 06782 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 06783 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 06784 continue; 06785 06786 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 06787 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 06788 CandidateSet); 06789 } 06790 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06791 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 06792 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 06793 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 06794 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 06795 06796 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 06797 // candidate exists. 06798 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) || 06799 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 06800 CanonType))) 06801 continue; 06802 06803 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 06804 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 06805 CandidateSet); 06806 } 06807 06808 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 06809 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 06810 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) && 06811 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy, 06812 NullPtrTy))) { 06813 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 06814 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, 06815 CandidateSet); 06816 } 06817 } 06818 } 06819 } 06820 06821 // C++ [over.built]p13: 06822 // 06823 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 06824 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 06825 // 06826 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 06827 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 06828 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 06829 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 06830 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 06831 // 06832 // C++ [over.built]p14: 06833 // 06834 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 06835 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 06836 // 06837 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 06838 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 06839 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 06840 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 06841 06842 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 06843 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = { 06844 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 06845 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 06846 }; 06847 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06848 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 06849 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 06850 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 06851 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 06852 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 06853 continue; 06854 06855 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 06856 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 06857 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 06858 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 06859 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2, 06860 CandidateSet); 06861 } 06862 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 06863 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 06864 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 06865 continue; 06866 06867 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 06868 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes, 06869 Args, 2, CandidateSet); 06870 } 06871 } 06872 } 06873 } 06874 06875 // C++ [over.built]p12: 06876 // 06877 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 06878 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 06879 // 06880 // LR operator*(L, R); 06881 // LR operator/(L, R); 06882 // LR operator+(L, R); 06883 // LR operator-(L, R); 06884 // bool operator<(L, R); 06885 // bool operator>(L, R); 06886 // bool operator<=(L, R); 06887 // bool operator>=(L, R); 06888 // bool operator==(L, R); 06889 // bool operator!=(L, R); 06890 // 06891 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 06892 // between types L and R. 06893 // 06894 // C++ [over.built]p24: 06895 // 06896 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 06897 // candidate operator functions of the form 06898 // 06899 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 06900 // 06901 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 06902 // between types L and R. 06903 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 06904 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) { 06905 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 06906 return; 06907 06908 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 06909 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 06910 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 06911 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 06912 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 06913 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 06914 QualType Result = 06915 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy 06916 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right); 06917 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 06918 } 06919 } 06920 06921 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 06922 // conditional operator for vector types. 06923 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06924 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 06925 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 06926 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 06927 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06928 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 06929 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 06930 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 06931 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 06932 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy; 06933 if (!isComparison) { 06934 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType()) 06935 Result = *Vec1; 06936 else 06937 Result = *Vec2; 06938 } 06939 06940 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 06941 } 06942 } 06943 } 06944 06945 // C++ [over.built]p17: 06946 // 06947 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 06948 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 06949 // 06950 // LR operator%(L, R); 06951 // LR operator&(L, R); 06952 // LR operator^(L, R); 06953 // LR operator|(L, R); 06954 // L operator<<(L, R); 06955 // L operator>>(L, R); 06956 // 06957 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 06958 // between types L and R. 06959 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 06960 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 06961 return; 06962 06963 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 06964 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 06965 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 06966 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 06967 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 06968 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 06969 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater) 06970 ? LandR[0] 06971 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right); 06972 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 06973 } 06974 } 06975 } 06976 06977 // C++ [over.built]p20: 06978 // 06979 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 06980 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 06981 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 06982 // 06983 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 06984 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 06985 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 06986 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 06987 06988 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 06989 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 06990 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 06991 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 06992 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 06993 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 06994 continue; 06995 06996 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2, 06997 CandidateSet); 06998 } 06999 07000 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07001 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 07002 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 07003 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 07004 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 07005 continue; 07006 07007 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2, 07008 CandidateSet); 07009 } 07010 } 07011 } 07012 07013 // C++ [over.built]p19: 07014 // 07015 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 07016 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 07017 // of the form 07018 // 07019 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 07020 // 07021 // C++ [over.built]p21: 07022 // 07023 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 07024 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 07025 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 07026 // 07027 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 07028 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 07029 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 07030 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 07031 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 07032 07033 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07034 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 07035 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 07036 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 07037 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 07038 if (isEqualOp) 07039 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 07040 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 07041 continue; 07042 07043 // non-volatile version 07044 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 07045 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 07046 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 07047 }; 07048 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 07049 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 07050 07051 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 07052 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 07053 // volatile version 07054 ParamTypes[0] = 07055 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 07056 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 07057 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 07058 } 07059 } 07060 07061 if (isEqualOp) { 07062 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07063 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 07064 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 07065 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 07066 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 07067 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 07068 continue; 07069 07070 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 07071 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 07072 *Ptr, 07073 }; 07074 07075 // non-volatile version 07076 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 07077 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 07078 07079 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 07080 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 07081 // volatile version 07082 ParamTypes[0] = 07083 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 07084 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 07085 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 07086 } 07087 } 07088 } 07089 } 07090 07091 // C++ [over.built]p18: 07092 // 07093 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 07094 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 07095 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 07096 // the form 07097 // 07098 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 07099 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 07100 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 07101 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 07102 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 07103 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 07104 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 07105 return; 07106 07107 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 07108 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 07109 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 07110 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 07111 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 07112 07113 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 07114 ParamTypes[0] = 07115 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 07116 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 07117 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 07118 07119 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 07120 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 07121 ParamTypes[0] = 07122 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 07123 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 07124 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 07125 CandidateSet, 07126 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 07127 } 07128 } 07129 } 07130 07131 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 07132 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07133 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 07134 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 07135 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 07136 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07137 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 07138 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 07139 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 07140 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 07141 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 07142 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 07143 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 07144 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 07145 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 07146 07147 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 07148 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 07149 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 07150 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 07151 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 07152 CandidateSet, 07153 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 07154 } 07155 } 07156 } 07157 } 07158 07159 // C++ [over.built]p22: 07160 // 07161 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 07162 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 07163 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 07164 // 07165 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 07166 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 07167 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 07168 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 07169 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 07170 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 07171 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 07172 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 07173 return; 07174 07175 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 07176 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 07177 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 07178 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 07179 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 07180 07181 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 07182 ParamTypes[0] = 07183 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 07184 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07185 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 07186 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 07187 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left); 07188 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 07189 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 07190 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, 07191 CandidateSet); 07192 } 07193 } 07194 } 07195 } 07196 07197 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 07198 // 07199 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 07200 // 07201 // bool operator!(bool); 07202 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 07203 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 07204 void addExclaimOverload() { 07205 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 07206 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet, 07207 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 07208 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 07209 } 07210 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 07211 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 07212 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet, 07213 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 07214 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 07215 } 07216 07217 // C++ [over.built]p13: 07218 // 07219 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 07220 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 07221 // 07222 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 07223 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 07224 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 07225 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 07226 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 07227 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 07228 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07229 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 07230 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 07231 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 07232 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 07233 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 07234 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 07235 continue; 07236 07237 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 07238 07239 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 07240 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07241 } 07242 07243 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07244 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 07245 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 07246 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 07247 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 07248 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 07249 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 07250 continue; 07251 07252 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType); 07253 07254 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 07255 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07256 } 07257 } 07258 07259 // C++ [over.built]p11: 07260 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 07261 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 07262 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 07263 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 07264 // 07265 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 07266 // 07267 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 07268 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 07269 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07270 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 07271 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 07272 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 07273 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 07274 QualType C1; 07275 QualifierCollector Q1; 07276 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 07277 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 07278 continue; 07279 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 07280 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 07281 // volatile/restrict type. 07282 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 07283 continue; 07284 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 07285 continue; 07286 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07287 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 07288 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 07289 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 07290 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 07291 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 07292 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 07293 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2)) 07294 break; 07295 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 07296 // build CV12 T& 07297 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 07298 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 07299 T.isVolatileQualified()) 07300 continue; 07301 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 07302 T.isRestrictQualified()) 07303 continue; 07304 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 07305 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 07306 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07307 } 07308 } 07309 } 07310 07311 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 07312 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 07313 // therefore added as binary. 07314 // 07315 // C++ [over.built]p25: 07316 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 07317 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 07318 // 07319 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 07320 // 07321 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 07322 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 07323 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 07324 07325 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 07326 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07327 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 07328 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 07329 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 07330 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr))) 07331 continue; 07332 07333 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 07334 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07335 } 07336 07337 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07338 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 07339 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 07340 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 07341 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr))) 07342 continue; 07343 07344 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 07345 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07346 } 07347 07348 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus0x) { 07349 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 07350 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 07351 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 07352 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 07353 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 07354 continue; 07355 07356 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum))) 07357 continue; 07358 07359 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 07360 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 07361 } 07362 } 07363 } 07364 } 07365 }; 07366 07367 } // end anonymous namespace 07368 07369 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 07370 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 07371 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 07372 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 07373 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 07374 void 07375 Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 07376 SourceLocation OpLoc, 07377 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 07378 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 07379 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 07380 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 07381 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 07382 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 07383 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 07384 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 07385 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 07386 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 07387 07388 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 07389 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 07390 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 07391 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 07392 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this)); 07393 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 07394 OpLoc, 07395 true, 07396 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 07397 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 07398 Op == OO_PipePipe), 07399 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 07400 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 07401 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 07402 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 07403 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 07404 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 07405 } 07406 07407 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 07408 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 07409 // 07410 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 07411 // 'bool' overloads. 07412 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 07413 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 07414 return; 07415 07416 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 07417 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs, 07418 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 07419 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 07420 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 07421 07422 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 07423 switch (Op) { 07424 case OO_None: 07425 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 07426 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 07427 07428 case OO_New: 07429 case OO_Delete: 07430 case OO_Array_New: 07431 case OO_Array_Delete: 07432 case OO_Call: 07433 llvm_unreachable( 07434 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 07435 07436 case OO_Comma: 07437 case OO_Arrow: 07438 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 07439 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 07440 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 07441 break; 07442 07443 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 07444 if (NumArgs == 1) 07445 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 07446 // Fall through. 07447 07448 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 07449 if (NumArgs == 1) { 07450 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 07451 } else { 07452 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 07453 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 07454 } 07455 break; 07456 07457 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 07458 if (NumArgs == 1) 07459 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 07460 else 07461 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 07462 break; 07463 07464 case OO_Slash: 07465 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 07466 break; 07467 07468 case OO_PlusPlus: 07469 case OO_MinusMinus: 07470 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 07471 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 07472 break; 07473 07474 case OO_EqualEqual: 07475 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 07476 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads(); 07477 // Fall through. 07478 07479 case OO_Less: 07480 case OO_Greater: 07481 case OO_LessEqual: 07482 case OO_GreaterEqual: 07483 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 07484 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true); 07485 break; 07486 07487 case OO_Percent: 07488 case OO_Caret: 07489 case OO_Pipe: 07490 case OO_LessLess: 07491 case OO_GreaterGreater: 07492 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 07493 break; 07494 07495 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 07496 if (NumArgs == 1) 07497 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 07498 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 07499 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 07500 break; 07501 07502 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 07503 break; 07504 07505 case OO_Tilde: 07506 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 07507 break; 07508 07509 case OO_Equal: 07510 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 07511 // Fall through. 07512 07513 case OO_PlusEqual: 07514 case OO_MinusEqual: 07515 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 07516 // Fall through. 07517 07518 case OO_StarEqual: 07519 case OO_SlashEqual: 07520 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 07521 break; 07522 07523 case OO_PercentEqual: 07524 case OO_LessLessEqual: 07525 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 07526 case OO_AmpEqual: 07527 case OO_CaretEqual: 07528 case OO_PipeEqual: 07529 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 07530 break; 07531 07532 case OO_Exclaim: 07533 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 07534 break; 07535 07536 case OO_AmpAmp: 07537 case OO_PipePipe: 07538 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 07539 break; 07540 07541 case OO_Subscript: 07542 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 07543 break; 07544 07545 case OO_ArrowStar: 07546 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 07547 break; 07548 07549 case OO_Conditional: 07550 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 07551 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false); 07552 break; 07553 } 07554 } 07555 07556 /// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 07557 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 07558 /// 07559 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 07560 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 07561 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 07562 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 07563 void 07564 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 07565 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc, 07566 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 07567 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 07568 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 07569 bool PartialOverloading, 07570 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) { 07571 ADLResult Fns; 07572 07573 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 07574 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 07575 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 07576 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 07577 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 07578 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 07579 07580 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 07581 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns, 07582 StdNamespaceIsAssociated); 07583 07584 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 07585 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 07586 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 07587 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 07588 if (Cand->Function) { 07589 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 07590 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 07591 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 07592 } 07593 07594 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 07595 // set. 07596 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 07597 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 07598 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 07599 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 07600 continue; 07601 07602 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 07603 PartialOverloading); 07604 } else 07605 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I), 07606 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 07607 Args, CandidateSet); 07608 } 07609 } 07610 07611 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 07612 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 07613 bool 07614 isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 07615 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 07616 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 07617 SourceLocation Loc, 07618 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 07619 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 07620 // functions. 07621 if (!Cand2.Viable) 07622 return Cand1.Viable; 07623 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 07624 return false; 07625 07626 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 07627 // 07628 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 07629 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 07630 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 07631 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 07632 unsigned StartArg = 0; 07633 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 07634 StartArg = 1; 07635 07636 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 07637 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 07638 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 07639 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 07640 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions; 07641 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 07642 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 07643 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 07644 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 07645 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 07646 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 07647 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 07648 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 07649 HasBetterConversion = true; 07650 break; 07651 07652 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 07653 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 07654 return false; 07655 07656 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 07657 // Do nothing. 07658 break; 07659 } 07660 } 07661 07662 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 07663 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 07664 if (HasBetterConversion) 07665 return true; 07666 07667 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 07668 // specialization, or, if not that, 07669 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) && 07670 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 07671 return true; 07672 07673 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 07674 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 07675 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 07676 // if not that, 07677 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() && 07678 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 07679 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 07680 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 07681 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 07682 Loc, 07683 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 07684 : TPOC_Call, 07685 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments)) 07686 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 07687 } 07688 07689 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 07690 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 07691 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 07692 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 07693 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 07694 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 07695 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 07696 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 07697 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 07698 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 07699 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 07700 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 07701 // pointer or block. 07702 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult 07703 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 07704 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 07705 return FuncResult; 07706 07707 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, 07708 Cand1.FinalConversion, 07709 Cand2.FinalConversion)) { 07710 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 07711 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 07712 return true; 07713 07714 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 07715 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 07716 return false; 07717 07718 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 07719 // Do nothing 07720 break; 07721 } 07722 } 07723 07724 return false; 07725 } 07726 07727 /// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 07728 /// within an overload candidate set. 07729 /// 07730 /// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions. 07731 /// 07732 /// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 07733 /// which overload resolution occurs. 07734 /// 07735 /// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 07736 /// function, Best points to the candidate function found. 07737 /// 07738 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 07739 OverloadingResult 07740 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 07741 iterator &Best, 07742 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 07743 // Find the best viable function. 07744 Best = end(); 07745 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 07746 if (Cand->Viable) 07747 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, 07748 UserDefinedConversion)) 07749 Best = Cand; 07750 } 07751 07752 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 07753 if (Best == end()) 07754 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 07755 07756 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 07757 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 07758 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) { 07759 if (Cand->Viable && 07760 Cand != Best && 07761 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, 07762 UserDefinedConversion)) { 07763 Best = end(); 07764 return OR_Ambiguous; 07765 } 07766 } 07767 07768 // Best is the best viable function. 07769 if (Best->Function && 07770 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || 07771 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function))) 07772 return OR_Deleted; 07773 07774 return OR_Success; 07775 } 07776 07777 namespace { 07778 07779 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 07780 oc_function, 07781 oc_method, 07782 oc_constructor, 07783 oc_function_template, 07784 oc_method_template, 07785 oc_constructor_template, 07786 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 07787 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 07788 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 07789 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 07790 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 07791 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor 07792 }; 07793 07794 OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, 07795 FunctionDecl *Fn, 07796 std::string &Description) { 07797 bool isTemplate = false; 07798 07799 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 07800 isTemplate = true; 07801 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 07802 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 07803 } 07804 07805 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 07806 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) 07807 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor; 07808 07809 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor()) 07810 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor; 07811 07812 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 07813 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 07814 07815 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 07816 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 07817 07818 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 07819 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 07820 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 07821 } 07822 07823 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 07824 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 07825 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 07826 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 07827 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method; 07828 07829 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 07830 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 07831 07832 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 07833 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 07834 07835 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 07836 return oc_method; 07837 } 07838 07839 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function; 07840 } 07841 07842 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) { 07843 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn); 07844 if (!Ctor) return; 07845 07846 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor(); 07847 if (!Ctor) return; 07848 07849 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor); 07850 } 07851 07852 } // end anonymous namespace 07853 07854 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 07855 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) { 07856 std::string FnDesc; 07857 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc); 07858 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 07859 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc; 07860 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 07861 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 07862 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn); 07863 } 07864 07865 //Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 07866 // OverloadedExpr 07867 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) { 07868 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 07869 07870 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 07871 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 07872 07873 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 07874 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 07875 I != IEnd; ++I) { 07876 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 07877 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 07878 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType); 07879 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 07880 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 07881 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType); 07882 } 07883 } 07884 } 07885 07886 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 07887 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 07888 /// target types of the conversion. 07889 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 07890 Sema &S, 07891 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 07892 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 07893 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 07894 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 07895 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator 07896 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 07897 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I); 07898 } 07899 } 07900 07901 namespace { 07902 07903 void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) { 07904 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 07905 assert(Conv.isBad()); 07906 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 07907 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 07908 07909 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 07910 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 07911 // conversion-slot index. 07912 bool isObjectArgument = false; 07913 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 07914 if (I == 0) 07915 isObjectArgument = true; 07916 else 07917 I--; 07918 } 07919 07920 std::string FnDesc; 07921 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 07922 07923 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 07924 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 07925 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 07926 07927 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 07928 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 07929 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 07930 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 07931 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 07932 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 07933 07934 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 07935 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 07936 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 07937 << ToTy << Name << I+1; 07938 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 07939 return; 07940 } 07941 07942 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 07943 // to a qualifier mismatch. 07944 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 07945 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 07946 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 07947 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 07948 else { 07949 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 07950 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 07951 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 07952 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 07953 } 07954 07955 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 07956 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 07957 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 07958 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 07959 07960 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 07961 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 07962 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 07963 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 07964 << FromTy 07965 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 07966 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 07967 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 07968 return; 07969 } 07970 07971 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 07972 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 07973 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 07974 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 07975 << FromTy 07976 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 07977 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 07978 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 07979 return; 07980 } 07981 07982 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 07983 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 07984 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 07985 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 07986 << FromTy 07987 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 07988 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 07989 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 07990 return; 07991 } 07992 07993 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 07994 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 07995 07996 if (isObjectArgument) { 07997 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 07998 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 07999 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08000 << FromTy << (CVR - 1); 08001 } else { 08002 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 08003 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 08004 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08005 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1; 08006 } 08007 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08008 return; 08009 } 08010 08011 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 08012 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 08013 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 08014 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 08015 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 08016 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08017 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 08018 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08019 return; 08020 } 08021 08022 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 08023 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 08024 // the failure. 08025 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 08026 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 08027 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 08028 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 08029 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 08030 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 08031 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08032 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 08033 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08034 return; 08035 } 08036 08037 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 08038 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 08039 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 08040 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 08041 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 08042 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 08043 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 08044 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 08045 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 08046 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 08047 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 08048 } 08049 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 08050 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 08051 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 08052 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 08053 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 08054 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 08055 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 08056 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 08057 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 08058 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 08059 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 08060 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 08061 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 08062 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 08063 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) 08064 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 08065 } 08066 08067 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 08068 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 08069 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 08070 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 08071 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08072 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) 08073 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1; 08074 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08075 return; 08076 } 08077 08078 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 08079 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 08080 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 08081 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 08082 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 08083 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 08084 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 08085 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08086 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 08087 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08088 return; 08089 } 08090 } 08091 08092 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 08093 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 08094 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 08095 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 08096 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1 08097 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind); 08098 08099 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 08100 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 08101 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 08102 FDiag << *HI; 08103 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 08104 08105 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08106 } 08107 08108 void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 08109 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 08110 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 08111 08112 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 08113 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 08114 08115 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 08116 08117 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 08118 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the 08119 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 08120 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 08121 // Just don't report anything. 08122 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 08123 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 08124 return; 08125 08126 // at least / at most / exactly 08127 unsigned mode, modeCount; 08128 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 08129 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 08130 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 08131 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 08132 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() || 08133 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 08134 mode = 0; // "at least" 08135 else 08136 mode = 2; // "exactly" 08137 modeCount = MinParams; 08138 } else { 08139 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 08140 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 08141 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 08142 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs()) 08143 mode = 1; // "at most" 08144 else 08145 mode = 2; // "exactly" 08146 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs(); 08147 } 08148 08149 std::string Description; 08150 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description); 08151 08152 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 08153 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 08154 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode 08155 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 08156 else 08157 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 08158 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode 08159 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 08160 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08161 } 08162 08163 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 08164 void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 08165 unsigned NumArgs) { 08166 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern 08167 08168 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 08169 NamedDecl *ParamD; 08170 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 08171 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 08172 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 08173 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) { 08174 case Sema::TDK_Success: 08175 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 08176 08177 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 08178 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 08179 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 08180 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 08181 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08182 return; 08183 } 08184 08185 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 08186 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 08187 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 08188 08189 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 08190 08191 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 08192 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 08193 QualifierCollector Qs; 08194 Qs.strip(Param); 08195 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 08196 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 08197 08198 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 08199 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 08200 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 08201 // done on dependent types). 08202 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 08203 08204 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 08205 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 08206 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08207 return; 08208 } 08209 08210 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 08211 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 08212 int which = 0; 08213 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 08214 which = 0; 08215 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 08216 which = 1; 08217 else { 08218 which = 2; 08219 } 08220 08221 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 08222 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() 08223 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 08224 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 08225 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08226 return; 08227 } 08228 08229 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 08230 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 08231 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 08232 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 08233 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 08234 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 08235 else { 08236 int index = 0; 08237 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 08238 index = TTP->getIndex(); 08239 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 08240 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 08241 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 08242 else 08243 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 08244 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 08245 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 08246 << (index + 1); 08247 } 08248 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08249 return; 08250 08251 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 08252 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 08253 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 08254 return; 08255 08256 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 08257 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 08258 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08259 return; 08260 08261 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 08262 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 08263 llvm::SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 08264 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 08265 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 08266 TemplateArgString = " "; 08267 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 08268 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 08269 } 08270 08271 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 08272 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 08273 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 08274 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 08275 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 08276 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 08277 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 08278 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 08279 return; 08280 } 08281 08282 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 08283 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 08284 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 08285 llvm::SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 08286 SourceRange R; 08287 if (PDiag) { 08288 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 08289 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 08290 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 08291 } 08292 08293 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 08294 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 08295 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08296 return; 08297 } 08298 08299 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 08300 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 08301 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 08302 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 08303 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 08304 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08305 return; 08306 } 08307 } 08308 08309 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 08310 void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 08311 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 08312 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 08313 08314 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 08315 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 08316 08317 std::string FnDesc; 08318 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc); 08319 08320 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 08321 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 08322 } 08323 08324 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 08325 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 08326 /// 08327 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 08328 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 08329 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 08330 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 08331 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 08332 /// overload. 08333 /// 08334 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 08335 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 08336 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 08337 void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 08338 unsigned NumArgs) { 08339 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 08340 08341 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 08342 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || 08343 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) { 08344 std::string FnDesc; 08345 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc); 08346 08347 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 08348 << FnKind << FnDesc 08349 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 08350 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn); 08351 return; 08352 } 08353 08354 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 08355 if (Cand->Viable) { 08356 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 08357 return; 08358 } 08359 08360 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 08361 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 08362 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 08363 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 08364 08365 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 08366 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs); 08367 08368 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 08369 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 08370 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 08371 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 08372 08373 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 08374 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 08375 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I) 08376 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 08377 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I); 08378 08379 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 08380 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 08381 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 08382 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn); 08383 } 08384 08385 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 08386 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 08387 } 08388 } 08389 08390 void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 08391 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 08392 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 08393 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 08394 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 08395 bool isLValueReference = false; 08396 bool isRValueReference = false; 08397 bool isPointer = false; 08398 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 08399 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 08400 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 08401 isLValueReference = true; 08402 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 08403 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 08404 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 08405 isRValueReference = true; 08406 } 08407 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 08408 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 08409 isPointer = true; 08410 } 08411 // Desugar down to a function type. 08412 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 08413 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 08414 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 08415 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 08416 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 08417 08418 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 08419 << FnType; 08420 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate); 08421 } 08422 08423 void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, 08424 const char *Opc, 08425 SourceLocation OpLoc, 08426 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 08427 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 08428 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 08429 TypeStr += Opc; 08430 TypeStr += "("; 08431 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 08432 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) { 08433 TypeStr += ")"; 08434 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr; 08435 } else { 08436 TypeStr += ", "; 08437 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 08438 TypeStr += ")"; 08439 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr; 08440 } 08441 } 08442 08443 void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 08444 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 08445 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions; 08446 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) { 08447 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx]; 08448 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 08449 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 08450 08451 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc, 08452 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 08453 } 08454 } 08455 08456 SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 08457 if (Cand->Function) 08458 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 08459 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 08460 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 08461 return SourceLocation(); 08462 } 08463 08464 static unsigned 08465 RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 08466 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 08467 case Sema::TDK_Success: 08468 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 08469 08470 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 08471 return 1; 08472 08473 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 08474 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 08475 return 2; 08476 08477 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 08478 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 08479 return 3; 08480 08481 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 08482 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: 08483 return 4; 08484 08485 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 08486 return 5; 08487 08488 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 08489 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 08490 return 6; 08491 } 08492 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 08493 } 08494 08495 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 08496 Sema &S; 08497 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 08498 08499 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 08500 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 08501 // Fast-path this check. 08502 if (L == R) return false; 08503 08504 // Order first by viability. 08505 if (L->Viable) { 08506 if (!R->Viable) return true; 08507 08508 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 08509 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 08510 // that could exploit it. 08511 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true; 08512 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false; 08513 } else if (R->Viable) 08514 return false; 08515 08516 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 08517 08518 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 08519 if (!L->Viable) { 08520 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 08521 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 08522 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 08523 return false; 08524 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 08525 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 08526 return true; 08527 08528 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 08529 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 08530 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 08531 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 08532 return true; 08533 08534 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 08535 // comes first. 08536 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 08537 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 08538 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 08539 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 08540 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 08541 if (numLFixes < numRFixes) 08542 return true; 08543 else 08544 return false; 08545 } 08546 08547 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 08548 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 08549 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions); 08550 08551 int leftBetter = 0; 08552 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 08553 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) { 08554 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, 08555 L->Conversions[I], 08556 R->Conversions[I])) { 08557 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 08558 leftBetter++; 08559 break; 08560 08561 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 08562 leftBetter--; 08563 break; 08564 08565 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 08566 break; 08567 } 08568 } 08569 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 08570 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 08571 08572 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 08573 return false; 08574 08575 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 08576 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 08577 return true; 08578 08579 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 08580 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 08581 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 08582 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 08583 return false; 08584 08585 // TODO: others? 08586 } 08587 08588 // Sort everything else by location. 08589 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 08590 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 08591 08592 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 08593 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 08594 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 08595 08596 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 08597 } 08598 }; 08599 08600 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 08601 /// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible. 08602 void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 08603 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 08604 assert(!Cand->Viable); 08605 08606 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 08607 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return; 08608 08609 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 08610 bool Unfixable = false; 08611 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 08612 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 08613 08614 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion. 08615 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 08616 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions; 08617 while (true) { 08618 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 08619 ConvIdx++; 08620 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) { 08621 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S); 08622 break; 08623 } 08624 } 08625 08626 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount) 08627 return; 08628 08629 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 08630 "remaining conversion is initialized?"); 08631 08632 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 08633 // operation somehow. 08634 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 08635 08636 const FunctionProtoType* Proto; 08637 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx; 08638 08639 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 08640 QualType ConvType 08641 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 08642 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 08643 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 08644 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 08645 ArgIdx--; 08646 } else if (Cand->Function) { 08647 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 08648 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 08649 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) 08650 ArgIdx--; 08651 } else { 08652 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion. 08653 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 08654 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx) 08655 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 08656 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx], 08657 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx], 08658 SuppressUserConversions, 08659 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true, 08660 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 08661 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 08662 return; 08663 } 08664 08665 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 08666 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 08667 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) { 08668 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) { 08669 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] 08670 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx), 08671 SuppressUserConversions, 08672 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 08673 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 08674 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 08675 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 08676 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 08677 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 08678 } 08679 else 08680 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 08681 } 08682 } 08683 08684 } // end anonymous namespace 08685 08686 /// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints 08687 /// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate 08688 /// set. 08689 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, 08690 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, 08691 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 08692 const char *Opc, 08693 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 08694 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 08695 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 08696 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 08697 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 08698 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 08699 if (Cand->Viable) 08700 Cands.push_back(Cand); 08701 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) { 08702 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args); 08703 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate) 08704 Cands.push_back(Cand); 08705 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 08706 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 08707 } 08708 } 08709 08710 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 08711 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 08712 08713 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 08714 08715 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E; 08716 const DiagnosticsEngine::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = 08717 S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 08718 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 08719 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 08720 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 08721 08722 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 08723 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 08724 // candidate list. 08725 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == DiagnosticsEngine::Ovl_Best) { 08726 break; 08727 } 08728 ++CandsShown; 08729 08730 if (Cand->Function) 08731 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size()); 08732 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 08733 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 08734 else { 08735 assert(Cand->Viable && 08736 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 08737 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 08738 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 08739 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 08740 // 08741 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 08742 // different ambiguities, though. 08743 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 08744 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 08745 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 08746 } 08747 08748 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 08749 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 08750 } 08751 } 08752 08753 if (I != E) 08754 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 08755 } 08756 08757 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 08758 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 08759 // R (A) --> R(A) 08760 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 08761 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 08762 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 08763 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 08764 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 08765 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 08766 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 08767 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 08768 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 08769 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 08770 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 08771 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 08772 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 08773 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 08774 Ret = 08775 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 08776 return Ret; 08777 } 08778 08779 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 08780 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 08781 class AddressOfFunctionResolver 08782 { 08783 Sema& S; 08784 Expr* SourceExpr; 08785 const QualType& TargetType; 08786 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 08787 08788 bool Complain; 08789 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 08790 ASTContext& Context; 08791 08792 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 08793 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 08794 08795 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 08796 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 08797 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 08798 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 08799 08800 public: 08801 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr, 08802 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain) 08803 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 08804 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 08805 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 08806 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 08807 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 08808 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 08809 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression) 08810 { 08811 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 08812 08813 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 08814 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 08815 DeclAccessPair dap; 08816 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 08817 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) { 08818 08819 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 08820 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 08821 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function 08822 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was 08823 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 08824 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 08825 08826 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 08827 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 08828 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 08829 return; 08830 } 08831 } 08832 08833 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn)); 08834 } 08835 } 08836 return; 08837 } 08838 08839 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 08840 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 08841 08842 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 08843 // C++ [over.over]p4: 08844 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 08845 if (Matches.size() > 1) { 08846 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 08847 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 08848 else 08849 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 08850 } 08851 } 08852 } 08853 08854 private: 08855 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 08856 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 08857 } 08858 08859 // [ToType] [Return] 08860 08861 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 08862 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 08863 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 08864 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 08865 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 08866 } 08867 08868 // return true if any matching specializations were found 08869 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 08870 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 08871 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 08872 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 08873 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 08874 // static when converting to member pointer. 08875 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 08876 return false; 08877 } 08878 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 08879 return false; 08880 08881 // C++ [over.over]p2: 08882 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 08883 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 08884 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 08885 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 08886 // overloaded functions considered. 08887 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 08888 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc()); 08889 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 08890 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 08891 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 08892 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 08893 Info)) { 08894 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 08895 (void)Result; 08896 return false; 08897 } 08898 08899 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match. 08900 // This function template specicalization works. 08901 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl()); 08902 assert(TargetFunctionType 08903 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType())); 08904 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 08905 return true; 08906 } 08907 08908 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 08909 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 08910 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 08911 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 08912 // when converting to member pointer. 08913 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 08914 return false; 08915 } 08916 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 08917 return false; 08918 08919 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 08920 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 08921 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 08922 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl)) 08923 return false; 08924 08925 QualType ResultTy; 08926 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, 08927 FunDecl->getType()) || 08928 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType, 08929 ResultTy)) { 08930 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, 08931 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 08932 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 08933 return true; 08934 } 08935 } 08936 08937 return false; 08938 } 08939 08940 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 08941 bool Ret = false; 08942 08943 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 08944 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 08945 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 08946 return false; 08947 08948 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 08949 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 08950 I != E; ++I) { 08951 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 08952 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 08953 08954 // C++ [over.over]p3: 08955 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 08956 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 08957 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 08958 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 08959 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 08960 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 08961 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 08962 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 08963 Ret = true; 08964 } 08965 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 08966 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 08967 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 08968 Ret = true; 08969 } 08970 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 08971 return Ret; 08972 } 08973 08974 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 08975 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 08976 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 08977 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 08978 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 08979 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 08980 08981 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 08982 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 08983 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 08984 // best function template (if it exists). 08985 08986 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 08987 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 08988 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 08989 08990 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = 08991 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), 08992 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), 08993 S.PDiag(), 08994 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 08995 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 08996 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 08997 << (unsigned) oc_function_template, 08998 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 08999 09000 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 09001 // Make it the first and only element 09002 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 09003 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 09004 Matches.resize(1); 09005 } 09006 } 09007 09008 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 09009 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 09010 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 09011 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 09012 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0) 09013 ++I; 09014 else { 09015 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 09016 Matches.set_size(N); 09017 } 09018 } 09019 } 09020 09021 public: 09022 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 09023 assert(Matches.empty()); 09024 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 09025 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 09026 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 09027 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType); 09028 } 09029 09030 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 09031 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 09032 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 09033 } 09034 09035 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 09036 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 09037 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 09038 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 09039 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 09040 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 09041 } 09042 09043 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 09044 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 09045 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 09046 } 09047 09048 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 09049 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 09050 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 09051 << OvlExpr->getName() 09052 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 09053 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType); 09054 } 09055 09056 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 09057 09058 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 09059 09060 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 09061 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0; 09062 return Matches[0].second; 09063 } 09064 09065 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 09066 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0; 09067 return &Matches[0].first; 09068 } 09069 }; 09070 09071 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 09072 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 09073 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 09074 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 09075 /// 09076 /// @code 09077 /// int f(double); 09078 /// int f(int); 09079 /// 09080 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 09081 /// @endcode 09082 /// 09083 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 09084 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 09085 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 09086 FunctionDecl * 09087 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 09088 QualType TargetType, 09089 bool Complain, 09090 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 09091 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 09092 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 09093 09094 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 09095 Complain); 09096 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 09097 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0; 09098 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) { 09099 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 09100 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 09101 else 09102 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 09103 } 09104 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain) 09105 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 09106 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 09107 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 09108 assert(Fn); 09109 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 09110 MarkFunctionReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn); 09111 if (Complain) 09112 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 09113 } 09114 09115 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 09116 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 09117 return Fn; 09118 } 09119 09120 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 09121 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 09122 /// 09123 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 09124 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 09125 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 09126 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 09127 FunctionDecl * 09128 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 09129 bool Complain, 09130 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 09131 // C++ [over.over]p1: 09132 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 09133 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 09134 // C++ [over.over]p1: 09135 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 09136 // operator. 09137 09138 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 09139 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 09140 return 0; 09141 09142 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 09143 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 09144 09145 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 09146 // whose type matches exactly. 09147 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0; 09148 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 09149 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 09150 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 09151 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 09152 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 09153 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 09154 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 09155 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 09156 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 09157 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 09158 09159 // C++ [over.over]p2: 09160 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 09161 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 09162 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 09163 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 09164 // overloaded functions considered. 09165 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0; 09166 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc()); 09167 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 09168 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 09169 Specialization, Info)) { 09170 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 09171 (void)Result; 09172 continue; 09173 } 09174 09175 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 09176 09177 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 09178 if (Matched) { 09179 if (Complain) { 09180 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 09181 << ovl->getName(); 09182 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 09183 } 09184 return 0; 09185 } 09186 09187 Matched = Specialization; 09188 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 09189 } 09190 09191 return Matched; 09192 } 09193 09194 09195 09196 09197 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 09198 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 09199 // 09200 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 09201 // 09202 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 09203 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 09204 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 09205 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 09206 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 09207 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining, 09208 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 09209 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 09210 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 09211 09212 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 09213 09214 DeclAccessPair found; 09215 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 09216 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 09217 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 09218 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) { 09219 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 09220 return true; 09221 } 09222 09223 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 09224 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 09225 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 09226 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 09227 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 09228 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 09229 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 09230 if (!complain) return false; 09231 09232 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 09233 diag::err_bound_member_function) 09234 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 09235 09236 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 09237 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 09238 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 09239 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 09240 // the static candidates were rejected. 09241 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 09242 return true; 09243 } 09244 09245 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'. 09246 SingleFunctionExpression = 09247 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn)); 09248 09249 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 09250 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 09251 SingleFunctionExpression = 09252 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take()); 09253 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 09254 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 09255 return true; 09256 } 09257 } 09258 } 09259 09260 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 09261 if (complain) { 09262 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 09263 << ovl.Expression->getName() 09264 << DestTypeForComplaining 09265 << OpRangeForComplaining 09266 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 09267 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 09268 09269 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 09270 return true; 09271 } 09272 09273 return false; 09274 } 09275 09276 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 09277 return true; 09278 } 09279 09280 /// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set. 09281 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 09282 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 09283 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 09284 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 09285 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 09286 bool PartialOverloading, 09287 bool KnownValid) { 09288 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 09289 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 09290 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 09291 09292 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 09293 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 09294 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 09295 return; 09296 } 09297 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 09298 PartialOverloading); 09299 return; 09300 } 09301 09302 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 09303 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 09304 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 09305 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet); 09306 return; 09307 } 09308 09309 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 09310 } 09311 09312 /// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 09313 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 09314 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 09315 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 09316 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 09317 bool PartialOverloading) { 09318 09319 #ifndef NDEBUG 09320 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 09321 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 09322 // 09323 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 09324 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 09325 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 09326 // 09327 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 09328 // 09329 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 09330 // using-declaration, or 09331 // 09332 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 09333 // template 09334 // 09335 // then Y is empty. 09336 09337 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 09338 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 09339 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 09340 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 09341 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 09342 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 09343 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 09344 } 09345 } 09346 #endif 09347 09348 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 09349 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 09350 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 09351 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 09352 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 09353 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 09354 } 09355 09356 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 09357 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 09358 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 09359 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 09360 /*KnownValid*/ true); 09361 09362 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 09363 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false, 09364 ULE->getExprLoc(), 09365 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 09366 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 09367 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace()); 09368 } 09369 09370 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 09371 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 09372 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 09373 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 09374 /// 09375 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 09376 static bool 09377 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 09378 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 09379 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 09380 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 09381 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty()) 09382 return false; 09383 09384 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 09385 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 09386 continue; 09387 09388 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 09389 09390 if (!R.empty()) { 09391 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 09392 09393 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 09394 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 09395 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 09396 R.clear(); 09397 return false; 09398 } 09399 09400 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc); 09401 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 09402 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 09403 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 09404 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 09405 09406 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 09407 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 09408 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 09409 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 09410 R.clear(); 09411 return false; 09412 } 09413 09414 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 09415 // declaring the function there instead. 09416 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 09417 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 09418 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, 09419 AssociatedNamespaces, 09420 AssociatedClasses); 09421 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 09422 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 09423 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) { 09424 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 09425 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 09426 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 09427 if (!Std->Encloses(*it)) 09428 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 09429 } 09430 } else { 09431 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces. 09432 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces; 09433 } 09434 09435 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 09436 << R.getLookupName(); 09437 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 09438 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 09439 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 09440 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 09441 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 09442 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 09443 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 09444 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 09445 } else { 09446 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 09447 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 09448 // a localized representation of a list of items. 09449 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 09450 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 09451 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 09452 } 09453 09454 // Try to recover by calling this function. 09455 return true; 09456 } 09457 09458 R.clear(); 09459 } 09460 09461 return false; 09462 } 09463 09464 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 09465 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 09466 /// was defined. 09467 /// 09468 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 09469 static bool 09470 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 09471 SourceLocation OpLoc, 09472 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 09473 DeclarationName OpName = 09474 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 09475 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 09476 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 09477 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args); 09478 } 09479 09480 namespace { 09481 // Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections 09482 // that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions) 09483 // that accept the given number of arguments. 09484 class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 09485 public: 09486 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs) 09487 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) { 09488 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 09489 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 09490 } 09491 09492 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) { 09493 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) 09494 return candidate.isKeyword(); 09495 09496 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(), 09497 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) { 09498 FunctionDecl *FD = 0; 09499 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 09500 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) 09501 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 09502 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) { 09503 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) { 09504 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function, 09505 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so, 09506 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee. 09507 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType(); 09508 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType()) 09509 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType(); 09510 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 09511 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs) 09512 return true; 09513 } 09514 } 09515 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs && 09516 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs) 09517 return true; 09518 } 09519 return false; 09520 } 09521 09522 private: 09523 unsigned NumArgs; 09524 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs; 09525 }; 09526 09527 // Callback that effectively disabled typo correction 09528 class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 09529 public: 09530 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() { 09531 WantTypeSpecifiers = false; 09532 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 09533 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 09534 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 09535 } 09536 09537 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) { 09538 return false; 09539 } 09540 }; 09541 } 09542 09543 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 09544 /// 09545 /// Returns true if new candidates were found. 09546 static ExprResult 09547 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 09548 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 09549 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 09550 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 09551 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 09552 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 09553 09554 CXXScopeSpec SS; 09555 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 09556 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 09557 09558 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 09559 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0; 09560 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 09561 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 09562 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 09563 } 09564 09565 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 09566 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 09567 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0); 09568 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll; 09569 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ? 09570 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator : 09571 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll; 09572 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 09573 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) && 09574 (!EmptyLookup || 09575 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC, 09576 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args))) 09577 return ExprError(); 09578 09579 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 09580 09581 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 09582 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 09583 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 09584 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 09585 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 09586 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs); 09587 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 09588 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 09589 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 09590 else 09591 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 09592 09593 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 09594 return ExprError(); 09595 09596 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 09597 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 09598 // end up here. 09599 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc, 09600 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 09601 RParenLoc); 09602 } 09603 09604 /// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn 09605 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 09606 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 09607 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 09608 /// the function declaration produced by overload 09609 /// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the 09610 /// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL. 09611 ExprResult 09612 Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 09613 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 09614 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 09615 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 09616 Expr *ExecConfig, 09617 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 09618 #ifndef NDEBUG 09619 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 09620 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 09621 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 09622 09623 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 09624 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 09625 FunctionDecl *F; 09626 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 09627 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 09628 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 09629 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 09630 09631 // We don't perform ADL in C. 09632 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 09633 } else 09634 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() && 09635 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL"); 09636 #endif 09637 09638 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 09639 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) 09640 return ExprError(); 09641 09642 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc()); 09643 09644 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 09645 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 09646 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 09647 CandidateSet); 09648 09649 // If we found nothing, try to recover. 09650 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail 09651 // out if it fails. 09652 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 09653 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then 09654 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup 09655 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base 09656 // classes. 09657 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() && 09658 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 09659 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs, 09660 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 09661 RParenLoc); 09662 CE->setTypeDependent(true); 09663 return Owned(CE); 09664 } 09665 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 09666 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs), 09667 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 09668 AllowTypoCorrection); 09669 } 09670 09671 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 09672 09673 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 09674 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) { 09675 case OR_Success: { 09676 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function; 09677 MarkFunctionReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl); 09678 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl); 09679 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()); 09680 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl); 09681 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc, 09682 ExecConfig); 09683 } 09684 09685 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 09686 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 09687 // have meant to call. 09688 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 09689 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs), 09690 RParenLoc, 09691 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 09692 AllowTypoCorrection); 09693 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 09694 return Recovery; 09695 09696 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 09697 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 09698 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 09699 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 09700 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 09701 break; 09702 } 09703 09704 case OR_Ambiguous: 09705 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 09706 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 09707 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 09708 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 09709 break; 09710 09711 case OR_Deleted: 09712 { 09713 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 09714 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 09715 << ULE->getName() 09716 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 09717 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 09718 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 09719 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 09720 09721 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep 09722 // the call in the AST. 09723 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function; 09724 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl); 09725 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, 09726 RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 09727 } 09728 } 09729 09730 // Overload resolution failed. 09731 return ExprError(); 09732 } 09733 09734 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 09735 return Functions.size() > 1 || 09736 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 09737 } 09738 09739 /// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 09740 /// operator. 09741 /// 09742 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 09743 /// 09744 /// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 09745 /// operator. 09746 /// 09747 /// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be 09748 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 09749 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 09750 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 09751 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 09752 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 09753 /// 09754 /// \param input The input argument. 09755 ExprResult 09756 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn, 09757 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 09758 Expr *Input) { 09759 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 09760 09761 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 09762 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 09763 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 09764 // TODO: provide better source location info. 09765 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 09766 09767 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 09768 return ExprError(); 09769 09770 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 }; 09771 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 09772 09773 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 09774 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 09775 // post-decrement. 09776 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 09777 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 09778 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 09779 SourceLocation()); 09780 NumArgs = 2; 09781 } 09782 09783 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 09784 if (Fns.empty()) 09785 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, 09786 Opc, 09787 Context.DependentTy, 09788 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 09789 OpLoc)); 09790 09791 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 09792 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 09793 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 09794 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 09795 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 09796 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 09797 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, 09798 &Args[0], NumArgs, 09799 Context.DependentTy, 09800 VK_RValue, 09801 OpLoc)); 09802 } 09803 09804 // Build an empty overload set. 09805 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc); 09806 09807 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 09808 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet, 09809 false); 09810 09811 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 09812 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet); 09813 09814 // Add candidates from ADL. 09815 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, 09816 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 09817 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0, 09818 CandidateSet); 09819 09820 // Add builtin operator candidates. 09821 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet); 09822 09823 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 09824 09825 // Perform overload resolution. 09826 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 09827 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 09828 case OR_Success: { 09829 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 09830 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 09831 09832 if (FnDecl) { 09833 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 09834 // operator. 09835 09836 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl); 09837 09838 // Convert the arguments. 09839 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 09840 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl); 09841 09842 ExprResult InputRes = 09843 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0, 09844 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 09845 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 09846 return ExprError(); 09847 Input = InputRes.take(); 09848 } else { 09849 // Convert the arguments. 09850 ExprResult InputInit 09851 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 09852 Context, 09853 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 09854 SourceLocation(), 09855 Input); 09856 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 09857 return ExprError(); 09858 Input = InputInit.take(); 09859 } 09860 09861 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 09862 09863 // Determine the result type. 09864 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 09865 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 09866 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 09867 09868 // Build the actual expression node. 09869 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 09870 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 09871 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 09872 return ExprError(); 09873 09874 Args[0] = Input; 09875 CallExpr *TheCall = 09876 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(), 09877 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 09878 09879 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 09880 FnDecl)) 09881 return ExprError(); 09882 09883 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 09884 } else { 09885 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 09886 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 09887 // operator node. 09888 ExprResult InputRes = 09889 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 09890 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 09891 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 09892 return ExprError(); 09893 Input = InputRes.take(); 09894 break; 09895 } 09896 } 09897 09898 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 09899 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 09900 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 09901 // defined too late to be candidates. 09902 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, 09903 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs))) 09904 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 09905 return ExprError(); 09906 09907 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 09908 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 09909 break; 09910 09911 case OR_Ambiguous: 09912 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 09913 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 09914 << Input->getType() 09915 << Input->getSourceRange(); 09916 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 09917 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 09918 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 09919 return ExprError(); 09920 09921 case OR_Deleted: 09922 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 09923 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 09924 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 09925 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 09926 << Input->getSourceRange(); 09927 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 09928 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 09929 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 09930 return ExprError(); 09931 } 09932 09933 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 09934 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 09935 // build a built-in operation. 09936 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 09937 } 09938 09939 /// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 09940 /// operator. 09941 /// 09942 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 09943 /// 09944 /// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this 09945 /// operator. 09946 /// 09947 /// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be 09948 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 09949 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 09950 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 09951 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 09952 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 09953 /// 09954 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 09955 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 09956 ExprResult 09957 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 09958 unsigned OpcIn, 09959 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 09960 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 09961 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 09962 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 09963 09964 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn); 09965 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 09966 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 09967 09968 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 09969 // expression. 09970 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 09971 if (Fns.empty()) { 09972 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 09973 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 09974 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 09975 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 09976 Context.DependentTy, 09977 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 09978 OpLoc)); 09979 09980 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 09981 Context.DependentTy, 09982 VK_LValue, 09983 OK_Ordinary, 09984 Context.DependentTy, 09985 Context.DependentTy, 09986 OpLoc)); 09987 } 09988 09989 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 09990 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 09991 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 09992 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 09993 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 09994 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 09995 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 09996 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 09997 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 09998 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, 09999 Args, 2, 10000 Context.DependentTy, 10001 VK_RValue, 10002 OpLoc)); 10003 } 10004 10005 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 10006 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 10007 return ExprError(); 10008 10009 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 10010 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 10011 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 10012 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 10013 return ExprError(); 10014 10015 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 10016 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 10017 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 10018 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 10019 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 10020 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 10021 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 10022 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 10023 10024 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 10025 // create a built-in binary operator. 10026 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 10027 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 10028 10029 // Build an empty overload set. 10030 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc); 10031 10032 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 10033 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false); 10034 10035 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 10036 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 10037 10038 // Add candidates from ADL. 10039 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, 10040 OpLoc, Args, 10041 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0, 10042 CandidateSet); 10043 10044 // Add builtin operator candidates. 10045 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 10046 10047 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10048 10049 // Perform overload resolution. 10050 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10051 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 10052 case OR_Success: { 10053 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 10054 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 10055 10056 if (FnDecl) { 10057 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 10058 // operator. 10059 10060 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl); 10061 10062 // Convert the arguments. 10063 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 10064 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 10065 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 10066 10067 ExprResult Arg1 = 10068 PerformCopyInitialization( 10069 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 10070 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 10071 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1])); 10072 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 10073 return ExprError(); 10074 10075 ExprResult Arg0 = 10076 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0, 10077 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 10078 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 10079 return ExprError(); 10080 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>(); 10081 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>(); 10082 } else { 10083 // Convert the arguments. 10084 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 10085 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 10086 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 10087 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0])); 10088 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 10089 return ExprError(); 10090 10091 ExprResult Arg1 = 10092 PerformCopyInitialization( 10093 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 10094 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 10095 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1])); 10096 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 10097 return ExprError(); 10098 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>(); 10099 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>(); 10100 } 10101 10102 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 10103 10104 // Determine the result type. 10105 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 10106 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10107 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10108 10109 // Build the actual expression node. 10110 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 10111 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 10112 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 10113 return ExprError(); 10114 10115 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 10116 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(), 10117 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 10118 10119 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 10120 FnDecl)) 10121 return ExprError(); 10122 10123 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10124 } else { 10125 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 10126 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 10127 // operator node. 10128 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 10129 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 10130 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 10131 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 10132 return ExprError(); 10133 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take(); 10134 10135 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 10136 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 10137 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 10138 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 10139 return ExprError(); 10140 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take(); 10141 break; 10142 } 10143 } 10144 10145 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 10146 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 10147 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 10148 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 10149 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 10150 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 10151 break; 10152 10153 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment 10154 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 10155 // no overloaded assignment operator found 10156 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 10157 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 10158 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 10159 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 10160 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10161 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10162 } else { 10163 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 10164 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 10165 // defined too late to be candidates. 10166 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 10167 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 10168 return ExprError(); 10169 10170 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 10171 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 10172 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 10173 } 10174 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 10175 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 10176 if (Result.isInvalid()) 10177 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10178 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 10179 return move(Result); 10180 } 10181 10182 case OR_Ambiguous: 10183 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 10184 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10185 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 10186 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10187 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 10188 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 10189 return ExprError(); 10190 10191 case OR_Deleted: 10192 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 10193 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10194 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 10195 << getSpecialMember(Method) 10196 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10197 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function); 10198 10199 if (getSpecialMember(Method) != CXXInvalid) { 10200 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 10201 // explain why it's deleted. 10202 NoteDeletedFunction(Method); 10203 return ExprError(); 10204 } 10205 } else { 10206 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 10207 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10208 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 10209 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10210 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10211 } 10212 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10213 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 10214 return ExprError(); 10215 } 10216 10217 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 10218 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 10219 } 10220 10221 ExprResult 10222 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 10223 SourceLocation RLoc, 10224 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 10225 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 10226 DeclarationName OpName = 10227 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 10228 10229 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 10230 // expression. 10231 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 10232 10233 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators 10234 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 10235 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 10236 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 10237 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 10238 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 10239 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 10240 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 10241 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 10242 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 10243 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 10244 10245 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, 10246 Args, 2, 10247 Context.DependentTy, 10248 VK_RValue, 10249 RLoc)); 10250 } 10251 10252 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 10253 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 10254 return ExprError(); 10255 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 10256 return ExprError(); 10257 10258 // Build an empty overload set. 10259 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc); 10260 10261 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 10262 10263 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 10264 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 10265 10266 // Add builtin operator candidates. 10267 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet); 10268 10269 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10270 10271 // Perform overload resolution. 10272 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10273 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 10274 case OR_Success: { 10275 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 10276 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 10277 10278 if (FnDecl) { 10279 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 10280 // operator. 10281 10282 MarkFunctionReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl); 10283 10284 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 10285 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc); 10286 10287 // Convert the arguments. 10288 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 10289 ExprResult Arg0 = 10290 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0, 10291 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 10292 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 10293 return ExprError(); 10294 Args[0] = Arg0.take(); 10295 10296 // Convert the arguments. 10297 ExprResult InputInit 10298 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 10299 Context, 10300 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 10301 SourceLocation(), 10302 Owned(Args[1])); 10303 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 10304 return ExprError(); 10305 10306 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>(); 10307 10308 // Determine the result type 10309 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType(); 10310 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10311 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10312 10313 // Build the actual expression node. 10314 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 10315 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 10316 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 10317 HadMultipleCandidates, 10318 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 10319 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 10320 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 10321 return ExprError(); 10322 10323 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 10324 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, 10325 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2, 10326 ResultTy, VK, RLoc); 10327 10328 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall, 10329 FnDecl)) 10330 return ExprError(); 10331 10332 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10333 } else { 10334 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 10335 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 10336 // operator node. 10337 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 10338 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0], 10339 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 10340 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 10341 return ExprError(); 10342 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take(); 10343 10344 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 10345 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1], 10346 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 10347 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 10348 return ExprError(); 10349 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take(); 10350 10351 break; 10352 } 10353 } 10354 10355 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 10356 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 10357 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 10358 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 10359 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10360 else 10361 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 10362 << Args[0]->getType() 10363 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10364 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10365 "[]", LLoc); 10366 return ExprError(); 10367 } 10368 10369 case OR_Ambiguous: 10370 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 10371 << "[]" 10372 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 10373 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10374 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 10375 "[]", LLoc); 10376 return ExprError(); 10377 10378 case OR_Deleted: 10379 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 10380 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]" 10381 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10382 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 10383 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 10384 "[]", LLoc); 10385 return ExprError(); 10386 } 10387 10388 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 10389 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 10390 } 10391 10392 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 10393 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 10394 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 10395 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 10396 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 10397 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 10398 /// member function. 10399 ExprResult 10400 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 10401 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args, 10402 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10403 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 10404 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10405 10406 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 10407 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 10408 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 10409 10410 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 10411 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 10412 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 10413 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 10414 10415 QualType fnType = 10416 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10417 10418 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10419 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 10420 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType()); 10421 10422 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 10423 // member function we're calling. 10424 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals()); 10425 10426 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 10427 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 10428 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10429 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 10430 10431 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 10432 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 10433 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 10434 if (difference) { 10435 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 10436 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 10437 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 10438 << qualsString 10439 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 10440 } 10441 10442 CXXMemberCallExpr *call 10443 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs, 10444 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc); 10445 10446 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(), 10447 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(), 10448 call, 0)) 10449 return ExprError(); 10450 10451 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc)) 10452 return ExprError(); 10453 10454 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 10455 } 10456 10457 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 10458 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) 10459 return ExprError(); 10460 10461 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 10462 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0; 10463 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public); 10464 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0; 10465 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 10466 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 10467 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 10468 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 10469 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 10470 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10471 } else { 10472 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 10473 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 10474 10475 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 10476 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 10477 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 10478 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 10479 10480 // Add overload candidates 10481 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc()); 10482 10483 // FIXME: avoid copy. 10484 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 10485 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 10486 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 10487 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 10488 } 10489 10490 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 10491 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 10492 10493 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 10494 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 10495 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 10496 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 10497 10498 10499 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 10500 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 10501 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), 10502 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet); 10503 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 10504 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 10505 // non-template member function. 10506 if (TemplateArgs) 10507 continue; 10508 10509 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 10510 ObjectClassification, 10511 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet, 10512 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 10513 } else { 10514 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), 10515 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs, 10516 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 10517 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 10518 CandidateSet, 10519 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false); 10520 } 10521 } 10522 10523 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 10524 10525 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10526 10527 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10528 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), 10529 Best)) { 10530 case OR_Success: 10531 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10532 MarkFunctionReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method); 10533 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 10534 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 10535 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()); 10536 break; 10537 10538 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10539 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 10540 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 10541 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 10542 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10543 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10544 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 10545 return ExprError(); 10546 10547 case OR_Ambiguous: 10548 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 10549 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 10550 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10551 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10552 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 10553 return ExprError(); 10554 10555 case OR_Deleted: 10556 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 10557 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10558 << DeclName 10559 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10560 << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 10561 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10562 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10563 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 10564 return ExprError(); 10565 } 10566 10567 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 10568 10569 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 10570 // non-member call based on that function. 10571 if (Method->isStatic()) { 10572 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, 10573 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc); 10574 } 10575 10576 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 10577 } 10578 10579 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType(); 10580 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 10581 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10582 10583 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 10584 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 10585 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs, 10586 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc); 10587 10588 // Check for a valid return type. 10589 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 10590 TheCall, Method)) 10591 return ExprError(); 10592 10593 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 10594 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 10595 // it was done at lookup. 10596 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 10597 ExprResult ObjectArg = 10598 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 10599 FoundDecl, Method); 10600 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 10601 return ExprError(); 10602 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take()); 10603 } 10604 10605 // Convert the rest of the arguments 10606 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 10607 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10608 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs, 10609 RParenLoc)) 10610 return ExprError(); 10611 10612 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs); 10613 10614 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall)) 10615 return ExprError(); 10616 10617 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 10618 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 10619 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 10620 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 10621 10622 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 10623 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 10624 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 10625 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 10626 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName(); 10627 10628 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 10629 } 10630 } 10631 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10632 } 10633 10634 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 10635 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 10636 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 10637 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 10638 ExprResult 10639 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 10640 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 10641 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs, 10642 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10643 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 10644 return ExprError(); 10645 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj); 10646 10647 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 10648 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) 10649 return ExprError(); 10650 10651 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument"); 10652 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 10653 10654 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 10655 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 10656 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 10657 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 10658 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 10659 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 10660 // (E).operator(). 10661 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc); 10662 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 10663 10664 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 10665 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 10666 return true; 10667 10668 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 10669 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 10670 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 10671 10672 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 10673 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 10674 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 10675 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, 10676 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false); 10677 } 10678 10679 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 10680 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 10681 // declared in T of the form 10682 // 10683 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 10684 // 10685 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 10686 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 10687 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 10688 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 10689 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 10690 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 10691 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 10692 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 10693 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 10694 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 10695 // within T by another intervening declaration. 10696 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions 10697 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 10698 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(), 10699 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) { 10700 NamedDecl *D = *I; 10701 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 10702 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 10703 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 10704 10705 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 10706 // surrogates. 10707 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 10708 continue; 10709 10710 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 10711 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 10712 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 10713 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 10714 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 10715 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 10716 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 10717 10718 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10719 { 10720 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 10721 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 10722 CandidateSet); 10723 } 10724 } 10725 } 10726 10727 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10728 10729 // Perform overload resolution. 10730 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10731 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10732 Best)) { 10733 case OR_Success: 10734 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 10735 // below. 10736 break; 10737 10738 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10739 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 10740 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 10741 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 10742 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10743 else 10744 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10745 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 10746 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10747 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10748 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10749 break; 10750 10751 case OR_Ambiguous: 10752 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10753 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 10754 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10755 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, 10756 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10757 break; 10758 10759 case OR_Deleted: 10760 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 10761 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 10762 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10763 << Object.get()->getType() 10764 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10765 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 10766 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 10767 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)); 10768 break; 10769 } 10770 10771 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 10772 return true; 10773 10774 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 10775 10776 if (Best->Function == 0) { 10777 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 10778 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 10779 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 10780 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 10781 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 10782 10783 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl); 10784 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc); 10785 10786 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 10787 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 10788 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job. 10789 10790 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 10791 // and then call it. 10792 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 10793 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 10794 if (Call.isInvalid()) 10795 return ExprError(); 10796 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 10797 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(), 10798 CK_UserDefinedConversion, 10799 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue)); 10800 10801 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), 10802 RParenLoc); 10803 } 10804 10805 MarkFunctionReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function); 10806 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl); 10807 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc); 10808 10809 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 10810 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 10811 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 10812 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 10813 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 10814 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10815 10816 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs(); 10817 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs; 10818 10819 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the 10820 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the 10821 // list). 10822 Expr **MethodArgs; 10823 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) { 10824 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto; 10825 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1]; 10826 } else { 10827 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1]; 10828 } 10829 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 10830 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) 10831 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx]; 10832 10833 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 10834 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 10835 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 10836 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, 10837 HadMultipleCandidates, 10838 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 10839 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 10840 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 10841 return true; 10842 10843 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly 10844 // owned. 10845 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType(); 10846 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 10847 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10848 10849 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 10850 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(), 10851 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1, 10852 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc); 10853 delete [] MethodArgs; 10854 10855 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, 10856 Method)) 10857 return true; 10858 10859 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more 10860 // slots in the call for them. 10861 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) 10862 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1); 10863 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) 10864 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto; 10865 10866 bool IsError = false; 10867 10868 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 10869 ExprResult ObjRes = 10870 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0, 10871 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 10872 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 10873 IsError = true; 10874 else 10875 Object = move(ObjRes); 10876 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take()); 10877 10878 // Check the argument types. 10879 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) { 10880 Expr *Arg; 10881 if (i < NumArgs) { 10882 Arg = Args[i]; 10883 10884 // Pass the argument. 10885 10886 ExprResult InputInit 10887 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 10888 Context, 10889 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 10890 SourceLocation(), Arg); 10891 10892 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 10893 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>(); 10894 } else { 10895 ExprResult DefArg 10896 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 10897 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 10898 IsError = true; 10899 break; 10900 } 10901 10902 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>(); 10903 } 10904 10905 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 10906 } 10907 10908 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 10909 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 10910 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 10911 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) { 10912 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0); 10913 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 10914 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take()); 10915 } 10916 } 10917 10918 if (IsError) return true; 10919 10920 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs); 10921 10922 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall)) 10923 return true; 10924 10925 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 10926 } 10927 10928 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 10929 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 10930 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 10931 ExprResult 10932 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 10933 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 10934 "left-hand side must have class type"); 10935 10936 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 10937 return ExprError(); 10938 10939 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 10940 10941 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 10942 // 10943 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 10944 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 10945 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 10946 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 10947 DeclarationName OpName = 10948 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 10949 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc); 10950 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 10951 10952 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 10953 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 10954 return ExprError(); 10955 10956 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 10957 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl()); 10958 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 10959 10960 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 10961 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 10962 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 10963 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 10964 } 10965 10966 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 10967 10968 // Perform overload resolution. 10969 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 10970 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 10971 case OR_Success: 10972 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 10973 break; 10974 10975 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 10976 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 10977 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 10978 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 10979 else 10980 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 10981 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 10982 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 10983 return ExprError(); 10984 10985 case OR_Ambiguous: 10986 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 10987 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 10988 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base); 10989 return ExprError(); 10990 10991 case OR_Deleted: 10992 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 10993 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 10994 << "->" 10995 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 10996 << Base->getSourceRange(); 10997 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 10998 return ExprError(); 10999 } 11000 11001 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function); 11002 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl); 11003 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc); 11004 11005 // Convert the object parameter. 11006 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 11007 ExprResult BaseResult = 11008 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0, 11009 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 11010 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 11011 return ExprError(); 11012 Base = BaseResult.take(); 11013 11014 // Build the operator call. 11015 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, 11016 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 11017 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 11018 return ExprError(); 11019 11020 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType(); 11021 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 11022 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11023 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 11024 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(), 11025 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc); 11026 11027 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 11028 Method)) 11029 return ExprError(); 11030 11031 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 11032 } 11033 11034 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 11035 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 11036 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 11037 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 11038 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 11039 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 11040 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 11041 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 11042 11043 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc); 11044 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true, 11045 TemplateArgs); 11046 11047 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 11048 11049 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 11050 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 11051 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11052 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 11053 case OR_Success: 11054 case OR_Deleted: 11055 break; 11056 11057 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 11058 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 11059 << R.getLookupName(); 11060 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11061 return ExprError(); 11062 11063 case OR_Ambiguous: 11064 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName(); 11065 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 11066 return ExprError(); 11067 } 11068 11069 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 11070 MarkFunctionReferenced(UDSuffixLoc, FD); 11071 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UDSuffixLoc); 11072 11073 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, HadMultipleCandidates, 11074 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 11075 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 11076 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 11077 return true; 11078 11079 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 11080 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 11081 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 11082 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 11083 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 11084 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 11085 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 11086 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 11087 return true; 11088 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take(); 11089 } 11090 11091 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType(); 11092 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 11093 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11094 11095 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = 11096 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(), ConvArgs, Args.size(), 11097 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc); 11098 11099 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 11100 return ExprError(); 11101 11102 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL)) 11103 return ExprError(); 11104 11105 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL); 11106 } 11107 11108 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 11109 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 11110 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 11111 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 11112 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 11113 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 11114 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 11115 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 11116 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 11117 Found, Fn); 11118 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 11119 return PE; 11120 11121 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 11122 } 11123 11124 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 11125 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 11126 Found, Fn); 11127 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 11128 SubExpr->getType()) && 11129 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 11130 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 11131 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 11132 return ICE; 11133 11134 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 11135 ICE->getCastKind(), 11136 SubExpr, 0, 11137 ICE->getValueKind()); 11138 } 11139 11140 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 11141 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 11142 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 11143 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 11144 if (Method->isStatic()) { 11145 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 11146 // from non-member functions. 11147 } else { 11148 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an 11149 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 11150 // or template. 11151 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 11152 Found, Fn); 11153 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 11154 return UnOp; 11155 11156 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 11157 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 11158 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 11159 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 11160 11161 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 11162 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 11163 // appropriate pointer to member type. 11164 QualType ClassType 11165 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 11166 QualType MemPtrType 11167 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 11168 11169 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 11170 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 11171 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 11172 } 11173 } 11174 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 11175 Found, Fn); 11176 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 11177 return UnOp; 11178 11179 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 11180 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 11181 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 11182 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 11183 } 11184 11185 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 11186 // FIXME: avoid copy. 11187 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 11188 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11189 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 11190 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 11191 } 11192 11193 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 11194 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), 11195 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 11196 Fn, 11197 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME? 11198 ULE->getNameLoc(), 11199 Fn->getType(), 11200 VK_LValue, 11201 Found.getDecl(), 11202 TemplateArgs); 11203 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 11204 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 11205 return DRE; 11206 } 11207 11208 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 11209 // FIXME: avoid copy. 11210 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0; 11211 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11212 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 11213 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 11214 } 11215 11216 Expr *Base; 11217 11218 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 11219 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 11220 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 11221 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 11222 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 11223 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 11224 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 11225 Fn, 11226 /*enclosing*/ false, 11227 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 11228 Fn->getType(), 11229 VK_LValue, 11230 Found.getDecl(), 11231 TemplateArgs); 11232 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 11233 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 11234 return DRE; 11235 } else { 11236 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 11237 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 11238 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 11239 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc); 11240 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, 11241 MemExpr->getBaseType(), 11242 /*isImplicit=*/true); 11243 } 11244 } else 11245 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 11246 11247 ExprValueKind valueKind; 11248 QualType type; 11249 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 11250 valueKind = VK_LValue; 11251 type = Fn->getType(); 11252 } else { 11253 valueKind = VK_RValue; 11254 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 11255 } 11256 11257 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base, 11258 MemExpr->isArrow(), 11259 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 11260 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 11261 Fn, 11262 Found, 11263 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 11264 TemplateArgs, 11265 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary); 11266 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 11267 return ME; 11268 } 11269 11270 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 11271 } 11272 11273 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 11274 DeclAccessPair Found, 11275 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 11276 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn)); 11277 } 11278 11279 } // end namespace clang